TIMERS, FLASHERS & EQUIPMENT CONTROLS CATALOG Timers • Flashers • Liquid Level Controls • Alternating Relays Current Sensors/Transducers • Voltage/Phase Monitors • Indicators We Are The GLOBAL EXPERTS in Electrical Safety and Productivity Global Resources for A Global Market From mining installations in Chile to semiconductor fabrication plants in Taiwan, customers trust Littelfuse electrical safety products and services to keep systems running and workers protected. Trollhättan Calgary Bellingham Rapid City Chicago Champaign Piedras Negras Muzquiz Kaunas Roskilde Norwich Swindon Bremen Saskatoon Winnipeg Lake Mills Baldwinsville Boston Noida Matamoros Our innovation, proven technical expertise, broad portfolio of products and services and global resources enable us to provide objective, comprehensive solutions for each unique application. Wuxi Suzhou Dongguan Shenzhen Seoul Shanghai Taipei Yokohama Hong Kong Lipa City Singapore São Paulo nnArc-Flash Relays nnGenerator Control & Protection nnVoltage/Phase Monitors nnNeutral-Grounding Resistors nnEngine Control & Diagnostics nnAlternating Relays nnMulti-Function Relays nnAlarm Monitors nnPump Controllers nnVoltage Protection nnCustom Power Centers nnLoad Sensors nnFuses and Fuse Holders nnEnhanced Overload Relays nnTimers WWW.SSAC.COM SSAC Now Part of Littelfuse Littelfuse acquired SSAC in 2014. Since 1968, SSAC, an ISO9001 certified and RoHS lead free compliant company, has been a leader in the design and manufacturing of timers, flashers and control products (commercial appliances, metering pumps, lab and test equipment, dairy equipment, boiler controls, HVAC/R controls, coin vending controls, pumping, motor and compressor relays, and controls for an assortment of process industries). SSAC is known for its reliable designs that provide long service lives with low maintenance costs. These reliable designs allow SSAC to back products with an industry leading 10-year warranty. Looking for a control board designed specifically to maximize a product’s functionality and eliminate extra wiring and setup costs? SSAC has over 30 years of experience designing and manufacturing custom control solutions. Our team of knowledgeable application engineers work with your engineering team to create custom controllers that reduce component cost and assembly time, eliminate unused features and provide system intelligence not possible when using individual components. Littelfuse products are certified to many standards around the world. To check certifications on specific product please refer to the product datasheet on Littelfuse.com. Index Accessories ............................... 149 AF .............................................. 107 ARP ........................................... 135 ASQU .......................................... 18 ASTU ........................................... 18 CT .............................................. 101 DCSA......................................... 126 DLMU .........................................111 DSQU .......................................... 19 DSTU ........................................... 19 ECS ........................................... 122 ECSW ........................................ 123 ERD3 ........................................... 82 ERDI ............................................ 58 ERDM .......................................... 25 ESD5 ........................................... 95 ESDR........................................... 86 FA155 ........................................ 137 FA165 ........................................ 137 FB120A, FB230A....................... 138 FB9L .......................................... 141 FS100 ........................................ 105 FS126 ........................................ 104 FS155 ........................................ 137 FS165 ........................................ 137 FS200 ........................................ 105 FS300 ........................................ 106 FS400 ........................................ 106 FS500 ........................................ 107 FSU ........................................... 104 HLMU ........................................ 112 HLV............................................ 119 HRD3 ........................................... 81 HRD9 ........................................... 67 HRDB .......................................... 44 HRDI ............................................ 70 HRDM .......................................... 24 HRDR .......................................... 80 HRDS .......................................... 57 HRID .............................................. 5 HRIS .............................................. 6 HRIU .............................................. 7 HRPD ............................................ 5 HRPS............................................. 6 HRPU ............................................ 7 HSPZ ............................................. 8 HRV ........................................... 102 KRD3 ........................................... 84 KRD9 ........................................... 68 KRDB........................................... 46 KRDI ............................................ 71 KRDM .......................................... 27 KRDR .......................................... 83 KRDS........................................... 60 KRPD............................................. 3 KRPS ............................................. 4 KSD1 ........................................... 33 KSD2 ........................................... 76 KSD3 ........................................... 91 KSD4 ........................................... 39 KSDB ........................................... 50 KSDR........................................... 88 KSDS ........................................... 64 KSDU........................................... 28 KSPD ............................................. 9 KSPS ........................................... 10 KSPU ........................................... 11 KVM ........................................... 120 LCS............................................ 127 LLC1 .......................................... 129 LLC2 .......................................... 130 LLC4 .......................................... 131 LLC5 .......................................... 132 LLC6 .......................................... 133 LLC8 .......................................... 134 LPM ........................................... 127 MSM ............................................ 36 NHPD .......................................... 12 NHPS........................................... 13 NHPU .......................................... 14 NLF ............................................ 147 ORB ............................................. 45 ORM ............................................ 26 ORS ............................................. 59 PCR ........................................... 143 PHS ........................................... 148 PLM ........................................... 114 PLMU......................................... 113 PLR............................................ 117 PLS ............................................ 118 PRLB ........................................... 43 PRLM........................................... 23 PRLS ........................................... 56 PTHF ........................................... 92 RS................................................ 85 SC3/4......................................... 108 SCR430T ...................................140 SCR490D .................................. 139 SCR630T ................................... 140 SCR9L ....................................... 142 SIR............................................. 145 SLR............................................ 146 SQ3/4 .......................................... 93 T2D .............................................. 97 TA .............................................. 99 TAC1 .......................................... 96 TAC4 ........................................... 98 TCS ........................................... 124 TCSA ......................................... 125 TDB ............................................. 41 TDBH ........................................... 41 TDBL ........................................... 41 TDI ............................................... 69 TDIH ............................................ 69 TDIL ............................................. 69 TDM ............................................. 21 TDMB .......................................... 94 TDMH .......................................... 21 TDML ........................................... 21 TDR ............................................. 79 TDS ............................................. 54 TDSH ........................................... 54 TDSL ........................................... 54 TDU ............................................. 28 TDUB ........................................... 47 TDUI ............................................ 72 TDUS ........................................... 61 TH1 .............................................. 35 TH2 .............................................. 78 THC ............................................. 66 THD1 ........................................... 32 THD2 ........................................... 74 THD3 ........................................... 89 THD4 ........................................... 38 THD7 ........................................... 52 THDB ........................................... 49 THDM .......................................... 31 THDS ........................................... 63 THS ............................................. 66 TL .............................................. 100 TMV8000 ..................................... 29 TRB ............................................. 42 TRDU ........................................... 16 TRM ............................................. 22 TRS ............................................. 55 TRU ............................................. 17 TS1 .............................................. 34 TS2 .............................................. 77 TS4 .............................................. 40 TS6 .............................................. 77 TSB.............................................. 53 TSD1 ........................................... 30 TSD2 ........................................... 73 TSD3 ........................................... 90 TSD4 ........................................... 37 TSD6 ........................................... 75 TSD7 ........................................... 51 TSDB ........................................... 48 TSDR ........................................... 87 TSDS ........................................... 62 TSS.............................................. 65 TSU2000 ..................................... 29 TVM ........................................... 116 TVW ........................................... 115 WVM .......................................... 110 TABLE OF CONTENTS Timers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 ProgramaCube. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Multifunction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Dedicated. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Flashers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Voltage Monitors & Phase Monitors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Current Sensors & Monitors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Liquid Level Controls & Alternating Relays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Tower & Obstruction Lighting Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Solid-State Relays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Appendix A - Timer Functions & Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Appendix B - Dimensional Drawings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 1 Series Included Relay Output - Single KRPD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 KRPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Power Relay Output Timers (ProgramaCube) 2 HRPD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HRID. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HRPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HRIS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HRPU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HRIU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 5 6 6 7 7 Solid-State Output - Dual HSPZ. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Solid-State Output KSPD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 KSPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 KSPU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Power Solid-State Output NHPD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 NHPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 NHPU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer KRPD Series Connection: L1 The KRPD Series is a factory programmed time delay relay available with 1 of 12 standard dual functions. The time delays can be factory fixed, onboard or externally adjustable or a combination of fixed and adjustable. The SPDT output relay contacts offer a full 10A rating with complete isolation. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRPD Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, accuracy and long life. Features: See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Auxiliary Products: Output Current/Ambient Temperature: N/L2 •Choose 1 of 12 standard dual functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Input voltage from 12 to 240V in 2 ranges •Delays from 100ms - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: •External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 • P/N: P1004-95-X •Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 •Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) •Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 •DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) •DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRPD12121MB KRPDA2825AMI KRPD215S190SMB KRPDA3232MB KRPD417M113MRXD KRPDA3434MB KRPDA11M14MRXE KRPDD2121MB KRPDA175S130SMI KRPDD3232RXE KRPDA2222RXE If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage C = Common, Transfer Contact NC = Normally Closed NO = Normally Open S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load A knob is supplied for adjustable units or RT terminals for external adjust. The untimed load is optional. S1 is not used for some functions. Order Table: KRPD X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC/DC ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─9 ─ - 230VAC X First Adjustment (T1 or RT1) ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust X First Time Delay* X Second Adjustment (T2 or RT2) ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-999) followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. X Second Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: MB, MRE, MI, MS, IRE, BRE, SRE, RXE, RXD, IM, AMI, SL For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed (to 999) Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 40ms; 750 operations per minute Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 48VDC; 24 to 240VAC/DC Tolerance 12 to 48VDC. . . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 240VAC/DC. . . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated relay contacts Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC 1/4 hp @ 125VAC Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) 3 Timer KRPS Series The KRPS Series is a factory programmed time delay relay available with 1 of 15 functions and measures only 2 inches square. The KRPS offers a wide range of fixed, onboard, or externally adjustable time delays. The output relay contacts offer a full 10A rating with complete isolation. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRPS Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, accuracy, and long life. Special time ranges and functions are available. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 Output Current/Ambient Temperature: N/L2 Features: •Choose 1 of 15 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Input voltage from 12 to 240V in 2 ranges •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRPS1110SM KRPSD10.1SF KRPS4160MM KRPSD10.1SM KRPS425M KRPSD10.5SS KRPS913MB KRPSD12STS KRPSA10.1SFT KRPSD13SB KRPSA10.5SFT KRPSD21B KRPSA110SM KRPSD21M KRPSA12MM KRPSD22M KRPSA12SM KRPSD22PSD KRPSA15SM KRPSD22S KRPSA21RE KRPSD24B KRPSA22B KRPSD24M KRPSA22PSD KRPSD25B KRPSA24M KRPSD25S KRPSA28PSE If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage C = Common, Transfer Contact NC = Normally Closed NO = Normally Open S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load A knob is supplied for adjustable units, or RT terminals 4 & 5 for external adjust. See external adjustment vs. time delay chart. The untimed load is optional. S1 is not used for some functions. Order Table: KRPS X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC/DC ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─9 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-1000) followed by (S) secs., (M) mins., or (H) hrs. X Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, I, TS, US, UB, AM, PSD, FT, F, SF For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12 to 48VDC. . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC/DC . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Microcontroller circuitry 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±2% ≤ 150ms ≤ 40ms; ≤ 750 operations per minute ≤ ±2% 12 to 48VDC; 24 to 240VAC/DC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT 10A resistive @ 125VAC 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC 1/4 hp @ 125VAC Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Life (Operations) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Encapsulated ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer HRID / HRPD Series The HRID/HRPD Series combines an electromechanical relay with microcontroller timing circuitry. It is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 12 standard functions. It offers 12 to 240V operation in two universal ranges and factory fixed, onboard or externally adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The high switching capacity of the output contacts allow for direct control of heavy loads like compressors, pumps, motors, heaters, and lighting. HRPD has non-isolated SPDT relay contacts, and the HRID has isolated SPDT relay contacts. An excellent choice for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Both offer dual functions in one convenient package. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 L1 N/L2 N/L2 HRID HRPD Relay contacts are isolated. Relay contacts are non-isolated. Features: •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 240V operation in 2 ranges •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRPDD2225RXE If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Optional Untimed Load NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: HRID / HRPD X Input ─W ─ - 24 to 240VAC ── 24 to 110VDC ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC X First Adjustment (T1 or RT1) X First Time Delay* X Second Adjustment (T2 or RT2) X Second Time Delay* X Function ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─Specify ─ function ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─1 ─ - Fixed ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust Functions: ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─3 ─ - External adjust MB, MRE, MI, MS, ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m IRE, BRE, SRE, RXE, ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m RXD, IM, AMI, SL ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-999) For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs. Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 2 to 48VDC. . . . . . . . . 24 to 110VDC/24 to 240VAC. . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings: General Purpose 125/240VAC Resistive 125/240VAC 28VDC 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ±2% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms; ≤ 1500 operations per minute ≤ ±2% 12 to 48VDC; 24 to 240VAC/24 to 110VDC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60Hz AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Electromechanical relay SPDT SPDT-N.O SPDT-NC 30A 15A 30A 15A 20A 10A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 6 Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 5 Electrical - 1 x 10 , *3 x104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥1500V RMS input to output; isolated units Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 5 Timer HRPS / HRIS Series The HRPS/HRIS Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 13 standard functions. It offers 12 to 240V operation in two universal ranges and factory fixed, onboard, or external adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. This series is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. The HRPS has non-isolated SPDT relay contacts, and the HRIS has isolated SPDT relay contacts. Both offer the most popular timer functions in the industry. Features: See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Connection: L1 N/L2 L1 N/L2 HRPS HRIS Relay contacts are isolated. Relay contacts are non-isolated. •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •Factory programmed •12 to 240V operation in 2 ranges •Special time ranges & functions available •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±2% factory calibration •Fixed, external, or onboard adjustment Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Available Models: HRISW21FT HRISW27I HRPSD12HI S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load (optional) NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: HRPS / HRIS X Input ─W ─ - 24 to 240VAC ── 24 to 110VDC ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-1000) followed by (S) secs., (M) mins., or (H) hrs. X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, I, TS, US, UB, AM, PSD, FT For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . ±2% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 48VDC; 24 to 240VAC/24 to 110VDC Tolerance 12 to 48VDC. . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 110VDC/240VAC . . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A 6 Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 6 Life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 5 Electrical - 1 x 10 , *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output; isolated units Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer HRPU / HRIU Series The HRPU/HRIU Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. Its switching capacity allows direct control of loads like compressors, pumps, motors, heaters, and lighting. It is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 14 standard functions. The HRPU/HRIU offers a single adjustable timer or counter function. Switch adjustment allows accurate selection of the time delay or number of counts. The HRPU has non-isolated relay contacts, the HRIU has isolated relay contacts. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The HRPU/HRIU Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, reliability and accurate switch adjustment. Connection: L1 Features: •Choose 1 of 14 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.1% repeat accuracy •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •Accurate switch adjustment •12 to 240V operations in 2 ranges •Delays from 0.1s - 1023h Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 Switch Adjustment: HRIU Isolated Output Available Models: HRIUW2I HRIUW2M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L1 * N/L2 * for selecting time in minutes or seconds HRPU Non-isolated Output S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Load V = Voltage Order Table: HRPU/ HRIU X Input ─W ─ - 24 to 240VAC 24 to 110VDC ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC X Time Delay/Counts ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023m ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3h ─6 ─ - 1 - 1023h ─7 ─ - 1 - 165 counts (straight) w/ pulsed output ─8 ─ - 1 - 1023 counts (binary) w/ pulsed output ─9 ─ - 1 - 7 counts to start 1 - 63s or m interval time X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, I, TS, PSD, US, AM, UB, C, CI For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Count Functions/Switch Type. . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical switch (counts on switch closure) Count Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 1023 counts Counter Output (Variable 7 & 8). . . . . . . . . . Pulse widths 300ms ±20% Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms, ≤ 1500 operations per minute Time Delay/Range ***. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable 0.1s - 1023h Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±1%, or 50ms, whichever is greater Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage.. . . . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 48VDC; 24 to 240VAC/24 to 110VDC AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% Tolerance 12 to 48VDC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 240VAC/24 to 110VDC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106 Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, ** 6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output; isolated units Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) ***For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 7 Timer HSPZ Series Connection: The HSPZ Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 13 standard functions. The HSPZ offers dual switch adjustable timer or counter functions. Switch adjustment allows accurate selection of the time delay or number of counts the first time and every time. The 1A steady, 10A inrush rated solid-state output provides 100 million operations, typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The HSPZ Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, solid state reliability, and accurate switch adjustment. Features: See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 3 for dimensional drawing. Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Switch Adjustment: (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) L1 •Choose 1 of 13 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.1% repeat accuracy •1A, solid-state output •Accurate switch adjustment •12 to 240V in 3 options •Delays from 0.1s - 1023h •Counts to 1023 Approvals: N/L2 Available Models: HSPZA13MS HSPZA22SL If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Load V = Voltage Order Table: HSPZ X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC ─P ─ - 12 to 120VDC positive switching ─N ─ - 12 to 120VDC negative switching X T1 Time Delay/Counts ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023m ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3h ─6 ─ - 1 - 1023h ─7 ─ - 1 - 165 counts (straight) ─8 ─ - 1 -1023 counts (binary) ─9 ─ - 1 - 512m or s X T2 Time Delay/Counts ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023m ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3h ─6 ─ - 1 - 1023h ─7 ─ - for future expansion ─8 ─ - for future expansion ─9 ─ - 1 - 512m or s X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: MB, MRE, MI, MS, IRE, BRE, SRE, RXE, RXD, IM, AMI, SL, CI For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Counter Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay Protection Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s, m or h in 0.1s, m or h increments Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 1023s, m or h in 1s, m or h increments Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 512s or m in 1s or m increments Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Mechanical Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Environmental Count Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 1023 in 2 ranges Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . Count Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 25 counts per second Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 120VDC; 24 to 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±15% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid-state output Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady, 10A inrush for 16ms Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 240VAC; DC ≅ 1mA 8 Output pulse width: 300ms ±20% Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer KSPD Series The KSPD Series is a factory programmed module available with 1 of 12 standard dual functions. The time delays can be factory fixed, externally or onboard adjustable, or a combination of fixed and adjustable. The 1A steady, 10A inrush rated solid-state output provides 100 million operations, typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KSPD Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size and long life. Features: See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Connection: L1 N/L2 •Choose 1 of 12 standard dual functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •1A steady, solid-state output , 10A inrush •12 to 240V in 3 options •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) Available Models: KSPD32221RXD KSPDA2222RXE KSPD4175S130SMS KSPDP10.1S31RXE KSPD42121MB KSPDP110M18SRXD KSPDA110ST00127 KSPDP110M18SRXE KSPDA114ST00173 KSPDP3131MI KSPDA2121RXE If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Terminal Location for External Adjustment. V = Voltage L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load T1 & RT1 = First Adjustment T2 & RT2 = Second Adjustment Order Table: KSPD X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC ─P ─ - 12 to 120VDC positive switching ─N ─ - 12 to 120VDC negative switching ─1 ─ - 120VDC positive switching ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC X First Adjustment (T1 or RT1) ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust X First Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Second Adjustment (T2 or RT2) ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-999) followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. X Second Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: MB, MRE, MI, MS, IRE, BRE, SRE, RXE, RXD, IM, AMI, SL For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed (to 999) Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms; ≤ 1500 operations per minute Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 120VDC; 24 to 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±15% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid-state output Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady, 10A inrush for 16ms www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 9 Timer KSPS Series The KSPS Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 14 standard functions. The KSPS offers a single, fixed, externally or onboard adjustable time delay. The 1A steady, 10A inrush rated solid-state output provides 100 million operations typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KSPS Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size and solid state reliability. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Choose 1 of 14 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •Solid-state output 1A steady, 10A inrush •Fixed, external, or onboard adjustment •12 to 240V in 3 options •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Connection: L1 N/L2 (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) Available Models: KSPS121TS KSPS124PS KSPS2180SB KSPS3115SRE KSPSA21FT KSPSA23SD KSPSA24B L = Load UTL = Untimed Load V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch KSPSA24US KSPSN110SI KSPSN21B KSPSP110SI KSPSP145SM KSPSP160MB If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: KSPS X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC ─P ─ - 12 to 120VDC positive switching ─N ─ - 12 to 120VDC negative switching ─1 ─ - 12VDC positive switching ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC positive switching X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, FT I, TS, US, UB, AM, PS, PSD *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-1000) followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Microcontroller circuitry 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±2% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms; ≤ 1500 operations per minute ≤ ±2% 12 to 120VDC; 24 to 240VAC ≤ ±15% 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Solid-state output 1A steady, 10A inrush for 16ms Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 240VAC, DC ≅ 1mA Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer KSPU Series The KSPU Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 14 standard functions. The KSPU offers a single adjustable timer or counter function. Switch adjustment allows accurate selection of the time delay or number of counts the first time and every time. The 1A steady, 10A inrush rated solid-state output provides 100 million operations, typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KSPU Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, solid state reliability, and accurate switch adjustment. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) * * for selecting time in minutes or seconds V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch L = Load UTL = Untimed Load •Choose 1 of 14 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Factory programmed •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.1% repeat accuracy •1A steady, solid-state output, 10A inrush •Accurate switch adjustment •12 to 240V in 3 options •Delays from 0.1s - 1023h •Counts 1 to 1023 Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Switch Adjustment: N/L2 Features: Available Models: KSPU11M KSPUA2I KSPUA8C If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build Order Table: KSPU X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC ─P ─ - 12 to 120VDC positive switching ─N ─ - 12 to 120VDC negative switching 1 - 12VDC positive switching ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─9 ─ - 120/240VAC X Time Delay/Counts ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023m ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3h ─6 ─ - 1 - 1023h ─7 ─ - 1 - 165 counts (straight) w/ pulsed output ─8 ─ - 1 - 1023 counts (binary) w/ pulsed output ─9 ─ - 1 - 7 counts to start 1 - 63s or m interval time X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, I, TS, US, UB, AM, PSD, C, CI For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s, m or h in 0.1s, m or h increments 1 - 1023s, m or h in 1s, m or h increments 1 - 63s or m in 1s or m increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Count Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 1023 in 3 ranges Count Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 25 counts per second Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 120VDC; 24 to 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±15% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid-state output Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady, 10A inrush for 16ms Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 240VAC; DC ≅ 1mA Counter Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output pulse width: 300ms ±20% Time Delay/Counts Variable 7 & 8 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 11 Timer NHPD Series The NHPD Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 12 standard dual functions. The time delays can be factory fixed, externally or onboard adjustable, or a combination of fixed and adjustable. The NHPD includes a high current solid-state output. It can switch motors, lamps and heaters directly without the addition of a contactor. It can switch up to 20A with up to 100 million operations typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The NHPD Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size and long life. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Factory programmed •Choose 1 of 12 standard dual functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •Fixed, external, or onboard adjustment •24 to 240VAC •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Available Models: There are no part numbers currently active. Please call Technical Support with your requirements. Terminal Location for External Adjustment V = Voltage L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load T1 & RT1 = First Adjustment T2 & RT2 = Second Adjustment Order Table: NHPD X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage X X X X X First Adjustment First Time Delay* Second Adjustment Second Time Delay* ──Function ─Specify ─ ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s (T1 or RT1) (T2 or RT2) ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-999) followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h function Functions: MB, MRE, MI, MS, IRE, BRE, SRE, RXE, RXD, IM, AMI, SL For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed (to 999) Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms; ≤ 1500 operations per minute Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±15% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Rating Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA 12 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mt with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer NHPS Series The NHPS Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 13 standard functions. The NHPS offers a single, fixed, onboard adjustment or an externally adjustable time delay. The NHPS includes a high current solid-state output. It can switch motors, lamps and heaters directly without the addition of a contactor. It can switch up to 20A with up to 100 million operations typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The NHPS Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size and solid state reliability. See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Factory programmed •Choose 1 of 13 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.5% repeat accuracy •Fixed, external, or onboard adjustment •24 to 240VAC •Delays from 0.1s - 1000h in 9 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Available Models: There are no part numbers currently active. Please call Technical Support with your requirements. Terminal Location for External Adjustment V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Untimed Load L = Load Order Table: NHPS X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─2 ─ - 1 - 100s ─3 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─4 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─5 ─ - 1 - 100m ─6 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 10h ─8 ─ - 1 - 100h ─9 ─ - 10 - 1000h X Function ─Specify ─ function Functions: M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, I, TS, US, UB, AM, FT, PSD For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-1000) followed by (S) secs., or (M) mins., or (H) hrs. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating Output A B C Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry 0.1s - 1000h in 9 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±2% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms; ≤ 1500 operations per minute ≤ ±2% 24 to 240VAC ≤ ±15% 50/60Hz Solid state Steady State Inrush** 6A 60A 10A 100A 20A 200A 100mA ≅ 2.5V @ rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000 V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 13 Timer NHPU Series Connection: L1 N/L2 The NHPU Series is a factory programmed module available in any 1 of 14 standard functions. The NHPU offers a single adjustable timer or counter function. Switch adjustment allows accurate selection of the time delay or number of counts, the first time and every time. The NHPU includes a high current solid-state output. It can switch motors, lamps and heaters directly without the addition of a contactor. It can switch up to 20A with up to 100 million operations, typical. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The NHPU Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, solid state reliability, and accurate switch adjustment. Features: See Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Switch Adjustment: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Factory programmed •Choose 1 of 14 standard functions •Special time ranges & functions available •Microcontroller circuitry, ±0.1% repeat accuracy •Accurate switch adjustment •24 to 240VAC •Delays from 0.1s - 1023h •Counts to 1023 Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Available Models: There are no part numbers currently active. Please call Technical Support with your requirements. * V = Voltage L = Load UTL = Untimed Load S1 = Initiate Switch * for selecting time in minutes or seconds Order Table: NHPU X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC X Time Delay/Counts X Function ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s ─Specify ─ function ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s Functions: ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m M, B, RE, RD, S, SD, ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023m ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3h I, TS, US, UB, AM, ─6 ─ - 1 - 1023h PSD, C, CI ─7 ─ - 1 - 165 counts (straight) w/ pulsed output ─8 ─ - 1 - 1023 counts (binary) w/ pulsed output ─9 ─ - 1 - 7 counts to start 1 - 63s or m interval time For a complete list of functions with descriptions and diagrams, see Appendix A - Timer Functions, pages 156-164. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s, m or h in 0.1s, m or h increments 1 - 1023s, m or h in 1s, m or h increments 1 - 63s or m in 1s or m increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Count Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 1023 in 3 ranges Count Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 25 counts per second Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±15% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Rating Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A 14 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Counter Output Time Delay/CountsVariable 7 & 8). . . . . Pulse width: 300ms ±20% Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting **. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mt. with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Series Included Relay Output TRDU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 TRU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 ASQU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ASTU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSQU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSTU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 18 18 19 19 Timiers - Multifunction Solid-State Output 15 Timer TRDU Series The TRDU Series is a versatile universal time delay relay with 21 selectable single and dual functions. The dual functions replace up to three timers required to accomplish the same function. Both the function and the timing range are selectable with switches located on the face of the unit. Two LED’s indicate input voltage and output status. This device offers full 10A isolated relay output contacts in either SPDT or DPDT. The TRDU replaces hundreds of part numbers, thereby, reducing your stock inventory requirements. 21 Functions: Connection: 8-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 8-pin SPDT L1 N/L2 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch Five switches are provided to set one of 10 single or 11 dual modes of operation. Single Functions *Delay-on-Make Delay-on-Break * Recycle (ON time first, equal recycle delays) Single Shot *Interval Trailing Edge Single Shot Inverted Single Shot Inverted Delay-on-Break Accumulative Delay-on-Make Retriggerable Single Shot (motion detector) Dual Functions Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break * Delay-on-Make/Recycle (ON time first, equal recycle delays) * Delay-on-Make/Interval Delay-on-Make/Single Shot * Interval/Recycle (ON time first, equal recycle delays) Delay-on-Break/Recycle (ON time first, equal recycle delays) Single Shot/Recycle (ON time first, equal recycle delays) * Recycle - both times adjust. (ON time first) * Recycle - both times adjust. (OFF time first) * Interval/Delay-on-Make Accumulative Delay-on-Make/Interval Features: •Microcontroller ±0.1% repeat accuracy •Multifunction – 21 timing functions •Multirange – 0.1s - 1,705h in 8 ranges •Switch selectable modes, time delay, & ranges •AC & DC input voltages are available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: TRDU120A1 TRDU120A2 TRDU120A3 TRDU12D1 TRDU12D3 TRDU230A2 TRDU24A1 TRDU24A2 TRDU24A3 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. For more information see: Appendix A, page 163-164 for function diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 5 for dimensional drawing. Order Table: TRDU X Input Voltage ─12D ─ - 12VDC ─24A ─ - 24VAC/DC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Base Connection ─1 ─ - 8-pin DPDT* ─2 ─ - 8-pin SPDT ─3 ─ - 11-pin DPDT *Limited to 9 operating functions in 8-pin DPDT units Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller Range: Switch Selectable** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single Functions: 0.1s - 1,705h in 8 ranges Dual Functions: 0.1s - 3,100m each in 8 ranges Adjustments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Multiplier: 3 position DIP switches select 0.1, 1, 10, or 100 in s or m Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±1% or 50ms, whichever is greater Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Timing Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Five switches are provided to set one of twenty-one single or dual functions Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120VAC: 75ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ±1% Indication Two LEDs indicate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1) Input voltage applied 2) Output relay status Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12VDC, 24VAC/DC, 120VAC, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VAC/DC. . . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 230V ≤ 3W; 12VDC ≤ 2W 16 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28 VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical – 1 x 107; Electrical – 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (78.7 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or magnal 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5.8 oz (164 g) **For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer TRU Series Connection: 8-pin DPDT Delay-on-Make Interval Recycling L1 The TRU Series is a multifunction, knob adjustable, Universal Time Delay Relay. It includes six of the most popular timing functions selected by a slide switch. The time delay is knob adjustable and the time delay range is switch selectable. The repeat accuracy is + 0.1%. Both function and time range can be selected on the top face of the unit. In addition to multifunctioning and multiple time ranges, the TRU Series features universal input voltage; 19 to 264VAC and 19 to 30VDC and full 10A output relay. The TRU Series can directly replace up to 1000 competitive time delay relay models. Features: Operation A six position slide switch selects delay-on-make, interval, single shot, recycling (ON time first, Equal Recycle Delays), delay-on-break, and retriggerable single shot. 8-pin DPDT base wiring is limited to delay-on-make, interval, and recycling functions. All six functions are available in the 8-pin SPDT and 11-pin DPDT versions. • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 6 for dimensional drawing. •Microcontroller ±0.1% repeat accuracy •Six timing functions are switch selectable •0.1s - 1000m in six ranges •Knob adjustable time delay •Universal input voltage 19 to 264VAC & 19 to 30VDC •10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Available Models: TRU1 TRU2 TRU3 N/L2 8-pin SPDT L1 N/L2 Delay-on-Make Interval Single Shot Recycling (ON Time First, Equal Recycle Delays) Delay-on-Break Retriggerable Single Shot 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 S1 = Initiate Switch Order Table: Input Voltage 19 to 264VAC; 19 to 30VDC 19 to 264VAC; 19 to 30VDC 19 to 264VAC; 19 to 30VDC Base Wiring 8-pin DPDT 8-pin SPDT 11-pin DPDT Functions 3 6 6 Part Number TRU1 TRU2 TRU3 Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range: Switch Selectable*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges - 0.1 - 10, 1 - 100 or 10 - 1000s; 0.1 - 10, 1 - 100 or 10 - 1000m Adjustments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Multiplier: 4 position DIP switch selects x0.1, x1, x10, and s or m Time Setting: Onboard knob adjustment with 1 - 100 reference dial Two LEDs indicate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1) Input voltage applied 2) Output relay status Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or ±20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 300ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage - Universal Input Range. . . . . . . . . 19 to 264VAC and 19 to 30VDC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT & DPDT, isolated www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Transient. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 joules Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reversed polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.44 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (87.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or magnal 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) * For CE approved applications, power must be removed when a switch position is changed. 17 Timer ASQU / ASTU Series The ASQU/ASTU Series of 17.5 mm, knob adjustable, universal solid-state timers offer multiple functions, voltages, and time delay ranges. Choose one of 5 functions and 4 time delay ranges via 4 selection switches located on face of the unit. Adjustment through the time range is accomplished by an onboard knob. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 7 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 DOM A B A SS B R DOB A B Delay-on-Make & Recycling L1 A B R M 0.1-10s X1s C D E F 1-100s X10s C D E F 10-1000s X100s C D E F C D E F 1-100m DOM = Delay-on-Make SS = Single Shot/Interval R = Recycling DOB = Delay-on-Break N/L2 •17.5 mm package for high rail density •Microprocessor controlled with ±1% repeat accuracy •Multimode: 5 selectable functions •Multirange: knob adjustable from 0.1s - 100m •Multivoltage: 24 to 240VAC or 9 to 110VDC •0.7A steady, 10A inrush rated solidstate output Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Adjustment: N/L2 Features: X10m S • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: ASQUA3 ASQUD3 ASTUA3 ASTUD3 R = Range M = Multiplier S = Setting Single Shot, Interval & Delay-on-Break V = Voltage L = Load J= Wire Required for Interval Operation S1= Initiate Switch UTL = Optional Untimed Load Order Table: ASQU - Quick Connects ASTU - Terminal Blocks X Input Voltage ─A ─ - Universal AC Voltage ── (24 to 240VAC) ─D ─ - Universal DC Voltage (9 to 110VDC) X Base Adaptors ─3 ─ - Both - Surface & DIN rail adaptors with quick mount fasteners Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller based with ceramic resonator and watchdog circuitry Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knob with dial; 2 switches select 1 of 4 multipliers Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 10s, 1 - 100s, 10 - 1000s, 1 - 100m Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±1% or ±50ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . ±2% or ±50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 300ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single Shot & Delay-on-Break: ≤ 32ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . ±2%, or ±50ms, whichever is greater Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC: 24 to 240VAC; -20% - 10% DC: 9 to 110VDC; -0% - 20% @ -25°C 9.4 to 110VDC; -0% - 20% @ -40°C AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7A steady state, 10A inrush Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 0.7A; DC ≅ 1.5V @ 0.7A 18 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DIN Rail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination ASQU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ASTU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface DC units are reverse polarity protected Two base adaptors are available Snap on to 32 mm DIN 1 & 35 mm DIN 3 rail Two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws or quick mount fasteners 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals 0.197 in. (5 mm) push-on terminal blocks for up to #14 AWG (2.5 mm2) wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 4 oz (113 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer DSQU / DSTU Series The DSQU/DSTU Series of 17.5 mm, switch adjustable, universal solid-state timers offer multiple functions, voltages, and time delay ranges. Choose one of 5 functions and 4 time delay ranges via 4 selection switches located on face of the unit. Six switches adjust the time delay through the selected range. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 7 for dimensional drawing. Features: •17.5 mm package for high rail density •Microprocessor controlled with ±0.1% timing accuracy •Multimode: 5 selectable functions •Multirange: switch adjust from 0.1s - 63m •Multivoltage: 24 to 240VAC or 9 to 110VDC •0.7A steady, 10A inrush rated solid-state output Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Connection: L1 Adjustment: N/L2 DOM A B A SS B 0.1-6.3s A B R DOB A B Delay-on-Make & Recycling L1 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) R M I E F 0.1s C D E F 1s 10-630s X10s C D E F 10s 1-63m X1m C D E F 1m X1s 1-63s Available Models: DSQUA3 DSQUD3 DSTUA3 DSTUD3 R = Range M = Multiplier S = Setting I = Increments of time DOM = Delay-on-Make SS = Single Shot/Interval R = Recycling DOB = Delay-on-Break N/L2 S X0.1s C D ON Single Shot, Interval & Delay-on-Break V = Voltage L = Load J= Wire Required for Interval Operation S1= Initiate Switch (for Single Shot or Delay-on-Break) UTL = Optional Untimed Load 1 2 4 8 16 32 Add switches in ON position TD = 2+8+16=26 Order Table: DSQU - Quick Connects DSTU - Terminal Blocks X Input Voltage ─A ─ - Universal AC Voltage (24 to 240VAC) ─D ─ - Universal DC Voltage (9 to 110VDC) X Base Adaptors ─3 ─ - Both - Surface & DIN rail adaptors with quick mount fasteners Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller based with ceramic resonator and watchdog circuitry Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 switches adjust the time delay; 2 switches select 1 of 4 multipliers Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . x0.1s = 0.1 - 6.3s in 0.1s increments x1s = 1 - 63s in 1s increments x10s = 10 - 630s in 10s increments x1m = 1 - 63m in 1m increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or ±20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or ±50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 300ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single Shot & Delay-on-Break: ≤ 32ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . ±2% or ±50ms, whichever is greater Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC: 24 to 240VAC; -20% - 10% DC: 9 to 110VDC; -0% - 20% @ -25°C 9.4 to 110VDC; -0% - 20% @ -40°C AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . 50/60Hz / ≤ 10% Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DIN Rail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination DSQU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7A steady state, 10A inrush AC ≅ 2.5V @ 0.7A; DC ≅ 1.5V @ 0.7A IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface DC units are reverse polarity protected Two base adaptors are available Snap on to 32 mm DIN 1 & 35 mm DIN 3 rail Two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws or quick mount fasteners 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals 0.197 in. (5 mm) push-on terminal blocks for up to #14 AWG (2.5 mm2) wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 4.2 oz (119 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 19 Series Included Single Function Timers - Dedicated Delay-on-Make (ON Delay). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Series: TDM, TDMH, TDML, TRM, PRLM, HRDM, ERDM, ORM, KRDM, KSDU, TDU, TMV8000, TSU2000, TSD1, THDM, THD1, KSD1, TS1, TH1, MSM Delay-on-Make, Normally Closed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Series: TSD4, THD4, KSD4, TS4 Delay-on-Break (OFF Delay). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Series: TDB, TDBH, TDBL, TRB, PRLB, HRDB, ORB, KRDB, TDUB, TSDB, THDB, KSDB, TSD7, THD7, TSB Single Shot (Pulse Former). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Series: TDS, TDSH, TDSL, TRS, PRLS, HRDS, ERDI, ORS, KRDS, TDUS, TSDS, THDS, KSDS, TSS, THC, THS Single Shot, Retriggerable (Watchdog, Zero Speed). . . . . 67 Series: HRD9, KRD9 Interval (Impulse ON). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Series: TDI, TDIH, TDIL, HRDI, KRDI, TDUI, TSD2, THD2, TSD6, KSD2, TS2, TS6, TH2 Recycling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Series: TDR, HRDR, HRD3, ERD3, KRDR, KRD3, RS, ESDR, TSDR, KSDR, THD3, TSD3, KSD3 Percentage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Series: PTHF Sequencer SQ3 & SQ4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Dual Function Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Series: TDMB - Plug-In Delay-on-Make/Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Series: ESD5 HVAC Timers Solid-State Output TAC1 - Anti Short Cycle, Random Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . T2D - Anti Short Cycle, Random Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TAC4 - Bypass Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TA - Anti Short Cycle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TL - Anti Short Cycle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CT - Fan Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 97 98 99 100 101 Vending Timers HRV - Relay Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 20 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make TDM / TDMH / TDML Series The TDM Series is a delay-on-make timer that combines accurate digital circuitry with isolated, DPDT relay contacts in an industry standard 8-pin plug-in package. DIP switch adjustment allows precise selection of the time delay over the full time delay range. The TDM Series is the product of choice for custom control panel and OEM designers. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. Connection: Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: Features: •Switch settable time delay •Three time ranges from 0.1s - 10,230s •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •10A, DPDT output contacts •LED indication Approvals: 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: L1 TDM120AL TDMH24DL TDM12DL TDML110DL TDM230AL TDML120AL TDM24AL TDML12DL TDM24DL TDML230AL TDMH120AL TDML24DL TDMH24AL If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. N/L2 Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: TDM - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments TDMH - 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments TDML - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments X Input Voltage ─12D ─ - 12VDC ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X LED Indication ─L ─ Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . During Timing - TDMH: ≤ 500ms TDM, TDML: ≤ 300ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED glows during timing; relay is de-energized Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 110 VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110VAC/DC to 230VAC. . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 21 Timer - Delay-on-Make TRM Series The TRM Series is a combination of analog electronic circuitry and electromechanical relay output. It provides input to output isolation with a wide variety of input voltages and time ranges. Standard plug-in base wiring, fast reset, rugged enclosure, and good repeat accuracy make the TRM a select choice in any OEM application. Features: •10A, DPDT or SPDT output contacts •24 to 230V operation in ranges •8-pin or 11-pin plug-in •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s in multiple ranges •±2% repeat accuracy Approvals: Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: 8-pin octal DPDT L1 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External RT P/N Selection Table 8-pin octal SPDT L1 N/L2 11-pin DPDT Value Part Number 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm P1004-16 P1004-15 P1004-14 P1004-12 P1004-13 P1004-16-X P1004-15-X P1004-14-X P1004-12-X P1004-13-X Available Models: L1 TRM110D1Z30 TRM120A2X1 TRM120A2X30 TRM120A2Y180 N/L2 RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are isolated. If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TRM X ── Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment and Output Form ─1 ─ - Fixed, Octal, DPDT ─2 ─ - Knob Adjust, Octal, DPDT ─3 ─ - Lock Shaft Adjust, Octal, DPDT ─5 ─ - Ext. Adjust, 11-pin, DPDT without potentiometer ─6 ─ - Ext. Adjust, 11-pin, DPDT supplied with potentiometer ─8 ─ - Ext. Adjust, Octal, SPDT, without potentiometer ─9 ─ - Ext. Adjust, Octal, SPDT, with potentiometer X Time Tolerance ─X ─ - ±20% ─Y ─ - ±10% ─Z ─ - ±5% Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50ms - 10m in 15 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater Fixed Time Tolerance & Setting Accuracy. . . . ±5, 10, or 20% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing: ≤ 20ms During timing: 0.1% of max. time delay or 75ms, whichever is greater Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2.25W 22 TRM120A2Y60 TRM120A2Y600 TRM24A8Y5 TRM24D1Y1 X Time Delay* (seconds) ─120 ─ - 2 - 120 ─180 ─ - 2 - 180 ─240 ─ - 7 - 240 ─300 ─ - 7 - 300 ─360 ─ - 7 - 360 ─420 ─ - 7 - 420 ─480 ─ - 7 - 480 ─600 ─ - 7 - 600 *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 1 ─2 ─ - 0.05 - 2 ─3 ─ - 0.05 - 3 ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 5 ─10 ─ - 0.1 - 10 ─30 ─ - 1 - 30 ─60 ─ - 1 - 60 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated DPDT or SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input & output terminals Insulation Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin or 11-pin plug-In Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make PRLM Series The PRLM Series is designed for use in non-critical timing applications. It offers low cost, knob adjustable timing control, full 10A relay output, and onboard LED indication. The knob adjustment provides a guaranteed time range of up to 10 minutes in 6 ranges. The onboard LED indicates whether or not the unit is timing (flashing LED) as well as the status of the output. Operation (Delay-on-Make): The time delay is initiated when input voltage is applied. LED flashes during timing. At the end of the delay period, the output contacts energize. LED is on steady after the unit times out. Reset: Reset is accomplished by removal of input voltage. There is no false output when reset during timing. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. Connection: Features: •Knob adjustable time delay relay •Electronic circuit with electromechanical relay •Popular AC & DC operating voltages •Industry standard octal plug-in connection •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s in multiple ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration •LED indication •10A, DPDT output contacts •Isolated relay contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: L1 PRLM41180 PRLM423 N/L2 8-pin octal DPDT If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: PRLM X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Factory Fixed ─2 ─ - Adjustable X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─3 ─ - 1 - 60s ─4 ─ - 2 - 180s ─5 ─ - 7 - 480s ─6 ─ - 7 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 600s in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Knob adjust: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing: ≤ 20ms During timing: 0.1% of max. time delay or 75ms, whichever is greater Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 240VAC/DC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, DPDT www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 28VDC; 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Indication Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . During timing - flashing Output energized - on steady Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) 23 Timer - Delay-on-Make HRDM Series The HRDM Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five ranges and factory fixed, onboard, or external adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. This series is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •30A, SPDT, NO output contact •12 to 230V operation in 5 ranges •Encapsulated circuitry •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRDM114S HRDM120 HRDM220 HRDM221 HRDM222 HRDM223 HRDM224 HRDM3112S HRDM320 HRDM321 NO = Normally Open L = Load C = Common, Transfer Contact HRDM322 HRDM323 HRDM324 HRDM4130S HRDM413M HRDM415M HRDM420 HRDM421 HRDM422 HRDM423 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are not isolated. Order Table: HRDM X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20 ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . ±1%, ±5% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 230VAC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated, SPDT Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 24 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106 ; Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make ERDM Series Econo-Timers are a combination of digital electronics and a reliable electromechanical relay. These devices offer a DPDT relay output for relay logic circuits, and isolation of input to output voltages. Cost effective for OEM applications, such as random starting, sequencing ON, switch debouncing, anti-short cycling, and other common delay-on-make applications. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 10 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Encapsulated, digital circuitry •Isolated, 10A, DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-16 P/N: P1004-16-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ERDM1110S ERDM4210 ERDM123 ERDM422 ERDM126 ERDM423 ERDM128 ERDM425 ERDM222 ERDM427 ERDM310.5S ERDM429 ERDM324 ERDM6210 ERDM326 ERDM628 ERDM4110S ERDM629 ERDM4130S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. A knob, or terminals 9 & 10 are only included on adjustable units. Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: ERDM X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 1s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 5s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─4 ─ - 0.2 - 15s ─5 ─ - 0.3 - 30s ─6 ─ - 0.6 - 60s ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 5m ─8 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─9 ─ - 0.2 - 15m ─10 ─ - 1 - 100m ─11 ─ - 10 - 500m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 500m in 11 adjustable ranges or 0.1s - 1000m fixed Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed, onboard or external adjust Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 120VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120VAC/DC & 230VAC. . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated relay contacts Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Full Load - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.7 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 43.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 65°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5.7 oz (162 g) 25 Timer - Delay-on-Make ORM Series The ORM Series features open PC board construction for reduced cost. It has isolated, 10A, DPDT relay contacts and all connections are 0.25 in (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals. The time delay may be ordered as factory fixed, onboard knob, or external adjustment. Time delays from 0.05 - 300 seconds. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 11 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Time delays from 0.05s - 300s in 5 ranges or fixed •Low cost open PCB construction •10A, DPDT output contacts •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ORM120A110 ORM120A115 ORM120A145 ORM120A17 ORM120A25 ORM230A17 ORM24D13.5 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: ORM X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VAC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 30s ─3 ─ - 0.6 - 60s ─4 ─ - 1.2 - 120s ─5 ─ - 3 - 300s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 300) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 300s in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Adjustable: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing - ≤ 16ms; During timing - 0.1% of max. time delay or 75ms, whichever is greater Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25W 26 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT, Isolated Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 Protection Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with four #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.7 oz (77 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make KRDM Series The KRDM Series is a compact time delay relay measuring only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its solidstate timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRDM Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs Time Delay: Features: •Compact time delay relay •10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges or fixed •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 6 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Available Models: KRDM110.4S KRDM223 KRDM110.5S KRDM224 KRDM111.5S KRDM234 KRDM1110S KRDM310.2S KRDM111S KRDM320 KRDM1130S KRDM4110S KRDM120 KRDM4145S KRDM121 KRDM4160S KRDM2110M KRDM421 KRDM215M KRDM430 KRDM220 KRDM433 KRDM221 KRDM623 KRDM222 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed A knob is supplied for adjustable units, or RT terminals 4 & 5 for external adjust. See external adjustment vs time delay chart. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: Order Table: KRDM X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC/DC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VAC/DC. . . . . 110VDC 120 & 230VAC . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Encapsulated ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) 27 Timer - Delay-on-Make KSDU/ TDU Series The TDU and KSDU Series are encapsulated solidstate, delay-on-make timers that combine digital timing circuitry with universal voltage operation. The TDU offers DIP switch adjustment allowing accurate selection of the time delay over the full time delay range. The KSDU is factory fixed from 0.1s to 10,230s and does not include the DIP switch. These series are excellent choices for process control systems and OEM equipment. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: Features: •2 universal voltage ranges from 24 to 240VAC/DC •Digital integrated circuitry •Switch selectable delays from 0.1s - 2.8h in 3 ranges or factory fixed •±0.5% repeat accuracy •1A steady, 10A inrush •Totally solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSDU8110 KSDU811200 TDU3000A TDU3001A TDU3003A TDUH3000A TDUH3001A TDUL3000A TDUL3001A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. TDU has DIP switch adjustment; KSDU is fixed. Order Tables: KSDU X Input Voltage Range ─8 ─ - 24 to 120VAC/DC ─9 ─ - 100 to 240VAC/DC TDU Input Voltage Range 24 to 120VAC/DC 100 to 240VAC/DC 24 to 120VAC/DC 100 to 240VAC/DC 120 to 277VAC 24 to 120VAC/DC 100 to 240VAC/DC X Type ─1 ─ - Fixed X Time Delay (Seconds) ─Specify ─ fixed delay in seconds 0.1 - 10230 Time Range - Seconds 0.1 - 102.3 0.1 - 102.3 1 - 1023 1 - 1023 1 - 1023 10 - 10230 10 - 10230 Part Number TDUL3000A TDUL3001A TDU3000A TDU3001A TDU3003A TDUH3000A TDUH3001A Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range* Adjustable (TDU) . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10230s in 10s increments Fixed (KSDU). . . . . . Fixed from 0.1s - 10230s Repeat Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . . ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . ±5% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 120VAC/DC; 100 to 240VAC/DC AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C 28 Minimum Holding Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) * For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make TMV8000 / TSU2000 Series The TMV and TSU Series are universal voltage delay-on-make timers. Two models cover all the popular voltages and time delays. Available with knob or external adjust time delay. Its simple two terminals can easily be connected in series with a relay coil, contactor coil, solenoid, lamps, small motor, etc., to delay their energization, prevent short cycling or to sequence on various loads. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Operates from 24 to 240VAC/DC •Onboard or external adjust time delays •Delays from 5s - 8m •Totally solid state & encapsulated •1A steady, 10A inrush •Two terminal series connection with load Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TMV8000 TSU2000 Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. TMV has knob adjustment. TSU has external adjustment terminals 4 & 5. Order Table: Input Voltage Range 24 to 240VAC/DC 24 to 240VAC/DC Time Delay 5 - 480s 0.1 - 8m Adjustment External Onboard Part Number TSU2000 TMV8000 Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 480s (TSU2000) 0.1 - 8m (TMV8000) Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 100ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC/DC ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid State Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 55°C Minimum Holding Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 40mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 70°C / -30° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 29 Timer - Delay-on-Make TSD1 Series The TSD1 Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the time delay. The TSD1 Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 100 hours are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 100h •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •12 to 230V in 6 ranges •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSD11110S TSD1311.2S TSD1315S TSD1320 TSD1321 TSD1424 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TSD1 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 1 - 100h *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. (M) min. or (1 - 100) (H) hours. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Holding Current. . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 0.1s - 100h in 7 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±1% 12, 24, 120VDC; 24, 120, 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state NO, open during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≤ 40mA ≅ 7mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make THDM Series The THDM Series is a high power solid-state delay-on-make timer that is connected in series with the load. The THDM eliminates the need for a timer and a separate solid-state relay. A cost effective approach for controlling larger loads, such as motors, electric heating elements, and lamps. When mounted on a metal surface, it can switch loads up to 20A steady, 200A inrush. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output is energized and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: • High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush • Simple-to-use two terminal series connection • ± 0.5% repeat accuracy • Fixed or adjustable delays from 1s - 1000m • ± 10% factory calibration • 24, 120, or 230VAC • Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer • Solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-13 P/N: P1004-13-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. 1 - 1-100s 2 - 10-1000s 3 - 0.1-10m 4 - 1-100m 5 - 10-1000m VTP P/N VTP5G VTP5K VTP5N VTP5P VTP5R Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Available Models: There are no part numbers currently active. Please call Technical Support with your requirements. Order Table: THDM X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital intergrated circuitry 1s - 1000m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 10% After timing - ≤ 350ms; During timing - ≤150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Currents Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Effective Voltage Drop (V Line - V Load) Input Effective Drop 24VAC ≤ 3V 120VAC ≤ 3V 230VAC ≤ 5V Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 31 Timer - Delay-on-Make THD1 Series The THD1 Series combines accurate timing circuitry with high power solid-state switching. It can switch motors, lamps, and heaters directly without a contactor. You can reduce labor, component cost, and increase reliability with these small, easy-to-use, Digi-Power timers. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Totally solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THD1B410.5S THD1C231 THD1C232 THD1C233 THD1C234 THD1C235 THD1C415M S1 = Optional Low Current Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. THD1C431 THD1C432 THD1C433 THD1C434 THD1C435 THD1C6110S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: THD1 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . ≤ ±1% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Current Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A 32 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ rated current OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make KSD1 Series The KSD1 Series features two-terminal, seriesconnection with the load. The KSD1 Series is an ideal choice for delay-on-make timing applications. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for popular AC and DC voltages. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •12 to 230V in 5 options •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSD11120S KSD1320 KSD1122 KSD1412S KSD1123 KSD14130S KSD1133 KSD1420 KSD1230 KSD1431 KSD13110M KSD16130S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: KSD1 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Holding Current. . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC; 12 or 24VDC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state NO, open during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≤ 40mA ≅ 7mA @ 230VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 33 Timer - Delay-on-Make TS1 Series Versa-Timer offers proven reliability and performance with years of use in OEM equipment and commercial applications. This encapsulated general use timing module is capable of controlling load currents ranging from 5mA to 1A. May be connected in series with contactors, relays, valves, solenoids, small motors, and lamps. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Two terminal series connection with load •5mA - 1A load currents •Totally solid state & encapsulated •±2% repeat accuracy •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05s - 10m in 8 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) All Other Voltages 12VDC Time Delay VTP P/N Time Delay VTP P/N 1 - 0.05-3s 2 - 0.5-60s 3 - 2-180s 4 - 5-600s ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust VTP2A VTP2E VTP2F VTP2H Available Models: Order Table: X Input Voltage 1 - 0.05-1s 2 - 0.5-20s 3 - 2-60s 4 - 5-120s Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. TS1 VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP5N X Time Delay* (12VDC) ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 1s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 20s ─3 ─ - 2 - 60s ─4 ─ - 5 - 120s X Time Delay* (ALL other voltages) ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s TS1111 TS12110 TS121150 TS12120 TS12130 TS121360 TS1214 TS121420 TS12160 TS12190 TS1221 TS1222 TS1224 TS13115 TS1321 TS1410.1 TS1410.25 TS1411 TS14110 TS141180 TS1412 TS14120 TS14130 TS1415 TS1416 TS1418 TS1421 TS1422 TS1423 TS1424 TS1612 TS1615 TS1621 TS1622 *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 120) (12VDC) or (0.05 - 600) (other voltages) in secs. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range 12VDC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 120s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed (1 MΩ max. RT ) Other Voltages . . . . . . . 0.05 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . ≤ ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing – ≤ 16ms During timing – 0.1% of time delay or 75ms, whichever is greater Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24 or 120VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state 34 Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Holding Current. . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C 5mA ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 80°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make TH1 Series The TH1 Series is a solid-state relay and timer combined into one compact, easy-to-use control. This highly reliable device eliminates the need for a separate solid-state relay. When mounted to a metal surface, it can switch load currents up to 20A steady state, and 200A inrush. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •High current load capacity up to 20A with 200A inrush •Solid-state switching - no contact wear or arcing •Encapsulated •Fixed or adjustable time delays from 0.1 - 600s •± 2% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: TH1A421 TH1B633 TH1C415 TH1C621 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Optional Low Current Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TH1 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 600) in secs. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . ≤ ± 5% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±15% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Currents Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA ≅ 2.5V at rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 35 Timer - Delay-on-Make MSM Series The MSM replaces bi-metal type timing with reliable solid-state circuitry. There are no moving parts to arc or wear. It is a cost effective solution for OEM designers. It is available for printed circuit board mounting or surface mounting with a removable bracket and wire leads. The MSM offers immediate reset on removal of power. Operation (Delay-on-Make): The time delay begins upon application of input voltage. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 167, Figure 25 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Printed circuit mount or wire leads •Fixed delays from 0.05 - 180s •± 5% repeat accuracy •± 15% factory calibration •Two-wire series connection with the load •Fast reset Approvals: Available Models: MSM10.2W7 MSM10.5W6 MSM10.7W6 MSM11W6 MSM110W6 MSM130W9 MSM16W9 MSM190W6 MSM20.15W9 MSM210P3 MSM21W9 MSM22W6 MSM25W9 MSM30.7W6 MSM33W9 MSM360P1 MSM40.2W6 MSM420W6 MSM42W6 MSM610W9 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage L = Load R = Red Wire B = Black Wire Order Table: MSM X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Fixed Time Delay ─0.05 ─ - 180s X Wire Type ─P ─ - PC Mount Specify fixed time in seconds. ─W ─ - Stranded Wire Leads X Wire Length Inches (mm) ─1 ─ - 0.250 (6.35) ─2 ─ - 0.375 (9.53) ─3 ─ - 0.5 (12.70) ─4 ─ - 0.625 (15.88) ─5 ─ - 0.75 (19.05) ─6 ─ - 6.0 (152.4) ─7 ─ - 7.0 (177.8) ─8 ─ - 8.0 (203.2) ─9 ─ - 9.0 (228.6) Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog Circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 180s fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±5% Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . ±15% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 75ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . ±15% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid State Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5A steady state 25°C; 0.25A steady state 60°C Minimum Holding Current . . . . . . . . . . .40mA 36 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 0.5A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS input to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected a. PC mount 14 AWG (2.087mm2) wires (Can be inserted in AMP Miniature Spring Socket #645980-1) b. Stranded 18 AWG wire leads (0.933 mm2) with mounting bracket Environmental Operation / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -30° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P: ≅ 1.1 oz (31.2 g) W: ≅ 1.2 oz (34 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make TSD4 Series The TSD4 Digi-Timer is a delay-on-make timer with a normally closed solid-state output. The load is energized prior to and during the delay period. The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance are required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 100 hours are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Delay-on-Make NC): Upon application of input voltage, the load energizes immediately. When the initiate switch is closed, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the load de-energizes. Reset: When the initiate switch is reopened, the load energizes again and the time delay is reset. Removing input voltage resets the time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 100h •24, 120, or 230VAC •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSD44115S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TSD4 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 1 - 100h *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. (M) min. or (1 - 100) (H) hours. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100h in 7 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±1% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NC, closed before & during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 37 Timer - Delay-on-Make THD4 Series The THD4 utilizes solid-state circuitry and a solid-state relay in one easy to use control. The metallized mounting surface allows a metal panel to dissipate heat rather than adding an expensive heat sink. The solid-state output is rated 6, 10, or 20 amps steady and up to 200 amps inrush. Motors, heaters and valves can be switched directly, eliminating the expense of a separate contactor. The THD4 offers substantial performance, reliability, and cost advantages for OEM designers. Operation (Delay-on-Make NC): Upon application of input voltage, the load is energized immediately. When the initiate switch closes, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the load de-energizes. Reset: When the initiate switch is reopened, the load is again energized and the time delay is reset. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load current capacity up to 20A, 200A inrush •Load energized prior to & during timing •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •Totally solid state & encapsulated •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: There are no part numbers currently active. Please call Technical Support with your requirements. S1 = Low Current Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: THD4 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . ≤ ±1% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NC Rating Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A 38 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V at rated current OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make KSD4 Series The KSD4 Digi-Timer offers a delay-on-make function with normally closed solid-state output. The load is energized prior to and during the time delay. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for input voltages of 24, 120 or 230VAC. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Delay-on-Make NC): Upon application of input voltage, the load energizes immediately. When the initiate switch is closed, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the load deenergizes. Reset: When the initiate switch is reopened, the load energizes and the time delay is reset. Removing input voltage resets the time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSD4433 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: KSD4 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration. . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NC, closed before & during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 39 Timer - Delay-on-Make TS4 Series The TS4 Versa-Timer is an analog delay-on-make timer with a normally closed solid-state output. Unlike an interval timer, the load is energized prior to and during the time delay period. It can be used as a faster starting interval time delay when S1 is closed upon application of input voltage. Operation (Delay-on-Make NC): Upon application of input voltage, the load is energized immediately. When the initiate switch is closed, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the load deenergizes. Reset: When the initiate switch is reopened, the load again energizes and the time delay is reset. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Fixed or adjustable delay •Load energized prior to & during time delay •0.05 - 600s in 4 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay 1 - 0.05-3s 2 - 0.5-60s 3 - 2-180s 4 - 5-600s VTP P/N VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP5N Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Available Models: TS441180 TS4422 TS4611 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TS4 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in secs. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater; under fixed conditions Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NC, closed during timing 40 Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break TDB / TDBH / TDBL Series The TDB Series combines accurate digital circuitry with isolated, 10A, DPDT or SPDT contacts in an 8 or 11-pin plug-in package. The TDB Series features DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1-10,230 seconds in three ranges. The TDB Series is the product of choice for custom control panel and OEM designers. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied to the input before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output relay is energized. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened (trailing edge triggered). The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: N/L2 •Switch settable time delay •Three time ranges from 0.1s - 10,230s •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts •LED indication Approvals: 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 Available Models: 8-pin octal SPDT L1 Features: S1 = Initiate Switch Relay contacts are isolated. TDB120AL TDB120ALD TDB12D TDB230AL TDB24AL TDB24DL TDBH120AL TDBH120ALD TDBH24AL TDBL120AL TDBL120ALD TDBL24DL If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 Order Table: TDB - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments TDBH - 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments TDBL - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments X Input Voltage X LED* X Type Plug / Output Form ─12D ─ - 12VDC ─L ─ ─D ─ - 11-pin plug, DPDT ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─Blank ─ - Octal (8-pin) plug, SPDT ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC *Note: LED not available ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC on 12VDC units. Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range**. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ±5% Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED indicates relay is energized Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 60ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24/28, or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 3.25W www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.4 x 1.8 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) ** For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 41 Timer - Delay-on-Break TRB Series Features: The TRB Series combines an isolated, 10A electromechanical relay output with analog timing circuitry. False trigger of the TRB by a transient is unlikely because of the complete isolation of the circuit from the line prior to initiation. The initiate contact is common to one side of the line and may be utilized to operate other loads. Installation is easy due to the TRB’s industry standard 8 or 11-pin plug-in base wiring. Connection: 8-pin octal SPDT Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened (trailing edge triggered). The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. L1 N/L2 11-pin SPDT L1 N/L2 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 Order Table: TRB External RT P/N Selection Table Value Part Number 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm P1004-16 P1004-15 P1004-14 P1004-12 P1004-13 P1004-16-X P1004-15-X P1004-14-X P1004-12-X P1004-13-X •Onboard adjustable time delays •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s in multiple ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •AC and DC operating voltages are available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts Approvals: 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 • External adjust potentiometers: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: TRB120A1Y240 TRB120A2Y1 TRB120A2Y3 TRB120A2Y30 TRB120A3X600 TRB24A1Y0.2 TRB24A4Y60 TRB24D10Y10 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment and Output Form ─1 ─ - Fixed, Octal, SPDT ── (AC Volts only) ─2 ─ - Onboard Adjust, Octal, SPDT ── (AC Volts only) ─3 ─ - Lock Shaft Adjust, Octal, SPDT ── (AC Volts only) ─4 ─ - Onboard adjust, 11-pin, DPDT ─7 ─ - Ext. Adjust, 11-pin, SPDT ── without potentiometer ─10 ─ - Fixed, 11-pin, DPDT X Time Tolerance ─X ─ - ±20% ─Y ─ - ±10% ─Z ─ - ±5% *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. X Time Delay* (seconds) ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 1 ─2 ─ - 0.05 - 2 ─3 ─ - 0.05 - 3 ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 5 ─10 ─ - 0.1 - 10 ─30 ─ - 1 - 30 ─60 ─ - 1 - 60 ─120 ─ - 2 - 120 ─180 ─ - 2 - 180 ─240 ─ - 7 - 240 ─300 ─ - 7 - 300 ─360 ─ - 7 - 360 ─420 ─ - 7 - 420 ─480 ─ - 7 - 480 ─600 ─ - 7 - 600 Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed Time Tolerance & Setting Accuracy. . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . . 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Analog circuitry 50ms - 10m in 15 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater ±5, 10, or 20% ≤ 70ms ≤ 75ms ≤ 250ms ≤±10% 24/28 or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC (DC voltages on DPDT output models only) -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz ≤ 3.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Isolation Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input to output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break PRLB Series The PRLB Series is designed for use on noncritical timing applications. It offers low cost, knob adjustable timing control, full 10A relay output, and onboard LED indication. The knob adjustment provides a guaranteed time range of up to 10 minutes in 6 ranges. The onboard LED indicates whether or not the unit is timing (flashing LED) as well as the status of the output. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied at all times prior to and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output contacts transfer and remain transferred if no further action is taken. The LED is on steady. When the initiate switch is opened, the time delay is started. The LED flashes during timing. At the conclusion of the delay, the output contacts revert to their original unenergized position. Applying input voltage with the initiate switch closed will energize the load. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Onboard adjustable time delay relay •Electronic circuit with electromechanical relay •Popular AC & DC operating voltages •Industry standard octal plug-in connection •Time delays 0.05 - 600s in 6 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration •LED indication •10A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PRLB422 PRLB425 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L1 N/L2 S1 = Initiate Switch Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: PRLB X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Factory Fixed ─2 ─ - Adjustable X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─3 ─ - 1 - 60s ─4 ─ - 2 - 180s ─5 ─ - 7 - 480s ─6 ─ - 7 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 600s in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knob adjust: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 75ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 250ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 28VDC; 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/3 hp @ 120 & 240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Indication Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output energized - on steady Output energized & timing - flashing Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) 43 Timer - Delay-on-Break HRDB Series The HRDB Series combines an electromechanical, relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. The HRDB offers 12 to 230V operation in five options and factory fixed, external, or onboard adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The isolated output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. The HRDB is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load UTL = Untimed Load (optional) NO = Normally Open C = Common, Transfer Contact Features: •Isolated, 30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRDB1110M HRDB113S HRDB117S HRDB120 HRDB121 HRDB124 HRDB21A65M HRDB220 HRDB221 HRDB222 HRDB223 HRDB224 HRDB315M HRDB3160M HRDB320 HRDB321 HRDB322 HRDB323 HRDB324 HRDB4130S HRDB420 HRDB421 HRDB422 HRDB423 HRDB424 HRDB615M HRDB621 HRDB623 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are isolated. Dashed lines are internal connections. The untimed load is optional. Order Table: HRDB X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . 24 to 230VAC. . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings: General Purpose 125/240VAC Resistive 125/240VAC 28VDC 44 Microcontroller circuitry 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater ±1%, ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Electromechanical relay Isolated, SPDT SPDT-NO SPDT-NC 30A 15A 30A 15A 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 6 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; 5 4 Electrical - 1 x 10 , *3 x 10 , **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break ORB Series The ORB Series’ open PCB construction offers the user good economy without sacrificing performance and reliability. The output relay is available in isolated, 10A, DPDT or SPDT forms. The time delay may be ordered as factory fixed, onboard knob, or external adjustment. All connections are 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened (trailing edge triggered). The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 11 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Low cost open PCB construction •10A, DPDT or SPDT output contacts •Line voltage initiation •Delays from 0.05s - 300s in 5 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ORB120A160 ORB120A25 ORB24A15D ORB24A21D ORB24A25 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. SPDT DPDT Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: ORB X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* X Output Form ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─Blank ─ - SPDT ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 30s ─D ─ - DPDT ─3 ─ - 0.6 - 60s ─4 ─ - 1.2 - 120s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 300) in seconds. ─5 ─ - 3 - 300s Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 300s in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Adjustable: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 70ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25W www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with four #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30°to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.7 oz (77 g) 45 Timer - Delay-on-Break KRDB Series The KRDB Series is a compact time delay relay measuring only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRDB Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Compact time delay relay •Microcontroller circuitry •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 6 options •±5% factory calibration Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRDB1110S KRDB112.5S KRDB1120M KRDB115M KRDB1160M KRDB120 KRDB121 KRDB124 KRDB125 KRDB217S KRDB222 KRDB31120S KRDB415S KRDB420 KRDB421 KRDB422 KRDB424 KRDB425 V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed UTL = Untimed Load (optional) If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. A knob is supplied for adjustable units. The untimed load is optional. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature Order Table: KRDB X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC/DC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller with watchdog circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 40ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . -15% - 20% 110VDC, 120 or 230VAC . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated relay contacts Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC 46 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break Connection: L1 N/L2 TDUB Series The TDUB Series combines digital timing circuitry with universal voltage operation. Voltages of 24 to 240VAC and 12 to 24VDC are available in three ranges. The TDUB Series offers DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1 seconds to 102.3 minutes in three ranges. Its 1A rated output, ability to operate on multiple voltages, and wide range of switch selectable time delays make the TDUB Series an excellent choice for process control systems and OEM equipment. Features: Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened (trailing edge triggered). The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Auxiliary Products: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. •Switch selectable time setting •0.1s - 102.3m in 3 ranges •± 0.5% repeat accuracy •± 2% setting accuracy •1A, solid-state output •Wide voltage ranges Approvals: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: 1023-20 Available Models: TDUB3000A TDUB3002A TDUBH3002A TDUBL3002A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. UTL = Optional Untimed Load S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load Add the value of switches in the ON position for the total time delay. Order Table: Input Voltage Range 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC Time Range 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m Part Number TDUBL3000A TDUBL3001A TDUBL3002A TDUB3000A TDUB3001A TDUB3002A TDUBH3000A TDUBH3001A TDUBH3002A Specifications Time Delay Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments Repeat Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Input Voltage / Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC, 12 to 24VDC /±20% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed before and during timing Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Off State Leakage Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 47 Timer - Delay-on-Break TSDB Series The TSDB Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size, and accurate performance are required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Connection: (Positive Switching) L1 N/L2 Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 1% factory calibration •12VDC to 230VAC in 5 options •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSDB120P TSDB320P TSDB420 TSDB431 TSDB434 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Timed Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TSDB X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Switching Mode (VDC only) ─P ─ - Positive ─N ─ - Negative *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . 48 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC ±15% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10 % Solid state NO, closed before & during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A Positive or negative switching Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break THDB Series The THDB Series combines accurate timing circuitry with high power, solid-state switching. It can switch motors, lamps, and heaters directly without a contactor. You can reduce labor, component cost, and increase reliability with these small, easy-to-use, Digi-Power timers. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output energizes if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Totally solid-state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THDB231C THDB430C THDB232C THDB431C THDB233C THDB432C THDB234C THDB433C THDB235C THDB434C THDB4110MC THDB435C THDB421A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Timed Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: THDB X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . ≤ ±1% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed before & during timing Maximum Load Current Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ rated current ≅ 5mA @t 230VAC 100mA Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 49 Timer - Delay-on-Break Connection: L1 N/L2 (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) KSDB Series The KSDB is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for popular AC and DC voltages. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Features: Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output energizes if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. •Fixed or adjustable 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •12VDC to 230VAC in 6 ranges •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Available Models: KSDB1110MP KSDB320P KSDB1115SP KSDB324N KSDB1120SP KSDB330N KSDB113MP KSDB330P KSDB113SP KSDB334P KSDB1160SP KSDB4110S KSDB120P KSDB41150S KSDB134P KSDB4120M KSDB2115S KSDB4160S KSDB220 KSDB4190M KSDB231 KSDB431 KSDB312SN KSDB61150S KSDB314SP KSDB631 KSDB315SP If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: KSDB X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Switching Mode (VDC only) ─P ─ - Positive ─N ─ - Negative *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±10% 12, 24, or 120VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10 % Solid state NO, closed before & during timing o 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60 C OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A Positive or negative switching Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 80°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval/Delay-on-Break TSD7 Series The TSD7 utilizes only two terminals connected in series with the load. Interval timing mode period is achieved by using a small portion of the AC sine wave allowing sufficient voltage for circuit operation. It can be used as an interval timer to control or pulse shape the operation of contactors, solenoids, relays, and lamp loads. The TSD7 can be wired to delay on the break of a switch for energy saving fan delays. Connection: L1 N/L2 Interval Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the time delay begins. The output remains energized throughout the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until power is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Upon closure of SW1, the load is energized and the timer is reset (zero volts across its input terminals). Opening SW1 re-applies input voltage to the timer, the load remains energized and the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. If SW1 is open when power is applied, the load will energize for the time delay then de-energize. Reset: Reclosing SW1 resets the timer. Features: •Two terminal series connection to load •Fixed or adjustable 1s - 1000m in 5 ranges •Digital integrated circuitry •±0.5% repeat accuracy Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-13 P/N: P1004-13-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. 1 - 1-100s 2 - 10-1000s 3 - 0.1-10m 4 - 1-100m 5 - 10-1000m VTP P/N VTP5G VTP5K VTP5N VTP5P VTP5R Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Delay-on- Break Available Models: TSD72130S TSD7222 TSD74110M TSD7412S TSD7413S TSD7414M TSD7421 V = Voltage L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. TSD7423 TSD7424 TSD761120S TSD761180S TSD7611S TSD7621 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSD7 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m or (1 - 1000) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry 1s - 1000m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±10% ≤ 400ms ≤ ±2% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 45°C 40mA www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Effective Voltage Drop (VLine-VLoad) Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Effective Drop 24VAC 3V 120VAC 4V 230VAC 6V Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 51 Timer - Interval/Delay-on-Break THD7 Series The THD7 utilizes only two terminals connected in series with the load. Interval timing mode is achieved by using a small portion of the AC sine wave allowing sufficient voltage for circuit operation. The THD7 can be used for interval or delay-on-break timing. It is designed to operate large loads directly, such as motors, heater elements, and motor starters. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the time delay begins. The output remains energized throughout the time delay. At the end of the time delay the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until power is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Upon closure of SW1, the load energizes and the timer is reset (zero voltage across its input terminals). Opening SW1 re-applies input voltage to the timer, the load remains energized and the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay the output de-energizes. If SW1 is open when power is applied, the load will energize for the time delay then de-energize. Reset: Reclosing SW1 resets the timer. Connection: L1 N/L2 Interval For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Solid-state relay and timer combined •Two terminal series connection to load •Up to 20A steady state, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable delays from 1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-13 P/N: P1004-13-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay 1 - 1-100s 2 - 10-1000s 3 - 0.1-10m 4 - 1-100m 5 - 10-1000m Delay-onBreak VTP P/N VTP5G VTP5K VTP5N VTP5P VTP5R Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Available Models: THD72110SA THD7415SB THD7421C THD7612MA THD7621C V = Voltage L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: THD7 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (0.1 - 1000)(M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1s - 1000m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing: ≤150ms; During timing: ≤ 350ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed during timing Rating Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A 52 Effective Voltage Drop (VLine-VLoad) Input Effective Drop 24VAC ≤ 3V 120VAC ≤ 3V 230VAC ≤ 5V Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Break TSB Series The TSB Series is a totally solid-state, delay-onbreak timing module. The TSB is available with a fixed, external, or onboard adjustable time delay. Time Delays from 0.05 to 600 seconds, in 4 standard ranges, cover over 90% of all OEM and commercial appliance timing applications. The repeat accuracy is ±2%. Operating voltages of 24, 120, or 230VAC are available. The TSB’s 1A steady state, 10A rated, solid-state output is perfect for direct control of solenoids, contactors, relays, lamps, buzzers, and small heaters. The TSB can be surface mounted with a single screw, or snapped on a 35 mm DIN rail using the P1023-20 adaptor. Operation (Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch opens. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Loss of input voltage resets the output and the time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. S1 = Initiate Switch UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Load RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features: •Fixed or adjustable 0.05 - 600s in 4 ranges •Totally solid state & encapsulated •± 2% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSB2130 TSB2190 TSB222 TSB232 TSB4110 TSB41300 TSB414 TSB4170 TSB418 TSB4190 TSB422 TSB423 TSB424 TSB432 TSB434 TSB632 TSB634 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSB X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05s - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ ±10% ≤ 150ms 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed before & during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 53 Timer - Single Shot TDS / TDSH / TDSL Series The TDS Series combines accurate digital circuitry with isolated, 10A rated, DPDT or SPDT relay contacts in an 8 or 11-pin plug-in package. The TDS Series features DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1s to 10,230s in three ranges. The TDS Series is the product of choice for custom control panel and OEM designers. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied to the input before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output relay energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. 8-pin octal SPDT Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: L1 N/L2 Features: •Switch selectable time delay •Three time ranges from 0.1s - 10,230s •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts •LED indication Approvals: 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 Available Models: TDS120AL TDS120ALD TDS12D TDS230AL TDS24AL TDS24DL TDSH120AL TDSH120ALD TDSH24ALD TDSL120AL TDSL12D TDSL24D If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 S1 = Initiate Switch Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: TDS - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments TDSH - 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments TDSL - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments X Input Voltage ─12D ─ - 12VDC ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X LED* ─L ─ X Type of Plug /Output Form ─Blank ─ - Octal (8-pin) plug, SPDT ─D ─ - 11-pin Plug, DPDT * Note: LED not available in 12VDC Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range**. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ±5% Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED glows during timing; relay is energized Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 60ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24/28, or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 3.25W 54 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT & DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28 VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.4 x 1.8 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) **For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot TRS Series The TRS Series combines an isolated, 10A electromechanical, relay output with analog timing circuitry. False trigger of the TRS by a transient is unlikely because of the complete isolation of the circuit from the line prior to initiation. The initiate contact is common to one side of the line and may be utilized to operate other loads. Installation is easy due to the TRS’s industry standard 8 or 11-pin plug-in base wiring. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied to the input before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. Applying input voltage with the initiate switch closed will energize the load and begin the time delay. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: 8-pin octal SPDT L1 N/L2 N/L2 11-pin DPDT L1 N/L2 Order Table: TRS S1 = Initiate Switch Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC Value Part Number 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm 1M ohm 1.5M ohm 2M ohm 3M ohm 5M ohm P1004-16 P1004-15 P1004-14 P1004-12 P1004-13 P1004-16-X P1004-15-X P1004-14-X P1004-12-X P1004-13-X X Adjustment and Output Form X Time Tolerance ─1 ─ - Fixed, Octal, SPDT ─X ─ - ±20% (AC Volts only) ─Y ─ - ±10% ─2 ─ - Knob Adjust, Octal, SPDT ─Z ─ - ±5% (AC Volts only) ─3 ─ - Lock Shaft Adjust, Octal, SPDT (AC Volts only) ─4 ─ - Knob adjust, 11-pin, DPDT ─7 ─ - Ext. Adjust, 11-pin, SPDT without potentiometer ─10 ─ - Fixed, 11-pin, DPDT *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed Time Tolerance & Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05s - 10m in 15 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater ±5, 10, or 20% ≤ 70ms ≤ 75ms ≤ 250ms ≤±10% 24/28 or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC (DC voltages on DPDT output models only) -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz ≤ 3.25W www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 •Knob adjustable time delays •Fixed or adjustable 0.05 - 600s in 15 ranges •Analog circuitry •±2% repeat accuracy •AC & DC operating voltages are available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT & DPDT output contacts Approvals: 8-pin models UL listed when used in combination with P1011-6 socket only. Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Octal socket for UL listing: P/N: P1011-6 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: External RT P/N Selection Table 11-pin SPDT L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. Features: TRS120A1X300 TRS120A2X300 TRS120A4Z3 TRS24D7Z10 TRS24D7Z3 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. X Time Delay* (seconds) ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 1 ─2 ─ - 0.05 - 2 ─3 ─ - 0.05 - 3 ─5 ─ - 0.1 - 5 ─10 ─ - 0.1 - 10 ─30 ─ - 1 - 30 ─60 ─ - 1 - 60 ─120 ─ - 2 - 120 ─180 ─ - 2 - 180 ─240 ─ - 7 - 240 ─300 ─ - 7 - 300 ─360 ─ - 7 - 360 ─420 ─ - 7 - 420 ─480 ─ - 7 - 480 ─600 ─ - 7 - 600 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input & output terminals Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in or 11-pin plug-in Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) 55 Timer - Single Shot PRLS Series The PRLS Series is designed for use on non-critical timing applications. It offers low cost, knob adjustable timing control; full 10A relay output; and onboard LED indication. The knob adjustment provides a guaranteed time range of up to 10 minutes in 6 ranges. The onboard LED indicates whether or not the unit is timing (flashing LED) as well as the status of the output. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied to the input at all times prior to and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch (momentary or maintained) the output contacts transfer and the time delay is initiated. The LED flashes during timing. At the end of the delay, the output contacts revert to their original position. If the initiate switch is reclosed during timing, the time delay will not be affected. Applying input voltage with the intiate switch closed will energize the load and begin the time delay. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Knob adjustable time delay relay •Electronic circuit with electromechanical relay •AC & DC operating voltages •Standard, octal plug-in connection •Fixed or adjustable 0.05 - 600s in 6 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration •LED indication •10A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PRLS625 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L1 N/L2 S1 = Initiate Switch V = Voltage Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: PRLS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Factory Fixed ─2 ─ - Adjustable X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─3 ─ - 1 - 60s ─4 ─ - 2 - 180s ─5 ─ - 7 - 480s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─6 ─ - 7 - 600s delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 600s in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Knob adjust: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 75ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 250ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC; 12, 24, or 110VDC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT 56 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 28VDC; 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/3 hp @ 120 & 240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Indication Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output energized & timing - flashing Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin, plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot HRDS Series The HRDS Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five options and factory fixed, onboard or external adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. This series is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Encapsulated circuitry •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRDS120 HRDS124 HRDS21120S HRDS220 HRDS221 HRDS222 HRDS223 HRDS313M HRDS320 HRDS321 HRDS322 HRDS323 HRDS324 HRDS420 HRDS421 HRDS422 HRDS423 HRDS424 HRDS430 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. NO = Normally Open S1 = Initiate Switch L = Load C = Common, Transfer Contact NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are not isolated. Order Table: HRDS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . . . . 24 to 230VAC. . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings: General Purpose 125/240VAC Resistive 125/240VAC 28VDC Microcontroller circuitry 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20 ms, whichever is greater ±1%, ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Electromechanical relay Non-isolated, SPDT SPDT-NO SPDT-NC 30A 15A 30A 15A 20A 10A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 6 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; 5 4 Electrical - 1 x 10 , *3 x 10 , **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C/-40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 57 Timer - Interval/Single Shot ERDI Series Econo-Timers are a combination of digital electronics and an electromechanical relay. DPDT relay output for relay logic circuits, and isolation of input to output voltages. For applications, such as interval on, pulse shaping, minimum run time, etc. The ERD Series is encapsulated to protect the circuitry from shock, vibration and humidity. Connection: L1 N/L2 Interval Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, time delay begins, and output relay energizes. At the end of time delay, output de-energizes until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before & during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of initiate switch, output relay energizes for time delay. At the end of the delay, output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing initiate switch during timing has no affect on time delay. Output will energize if initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when time delay is complete & initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets time delay & output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 10 for dimensional drawing. L1 Features: •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 11 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 10% factory calibration •Encapsulated digital circuitry •Isolated 10A, DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-16 P/N: P1004-16-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ERDI1210 ERDI4311 ERDI123 ERDI436 ERDI323 ERDI628 ERDI326 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. N/L2 Single Shot 2-3 & 7-6 are Normally Open Contacts (NO) 2-4 & 7-5 are Normally Closed Contacts (NC) A knob, or terminals 9 & 10 are included on adjustable units. Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: ERDI X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC Specifications X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 1s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 5s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─4 ─ - 0.2 - 15s ─5 ─ - 0.3 - 30s ─6 ─ - 0.6 - 60s Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 500m in 11 adjustable ranges, 0.1s - 1000m fixed Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knob, external adjust, or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 120VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 120VDC/AC & 230VAC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated relay contacts 58 ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 5m ─8 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─9 ─ - 0.2 - 15m ─10 ─ - 1 - 100m ─11 ─ - 10 - 500m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (M) min. Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.7 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 43.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 65°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5.7 oz (162 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot ORS Series The ORS Series’ open PCB construction offers the user good economy without sacrificing performance and reliability. The output relay is available in isolated, 10A, DPDT or SPDT forms. The time delay may be ordered as factory fixed, onboard knob, or external adjustment. All connections are 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals. Connection: L1 N/L2 L1 N/L2 Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output relay energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 11 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Low cost open PCB construction •Momentary or maintained initiation •10A, DPDT or SPDT output contacts •Delays from 0.05s - 300s in 5 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±10% factory calibration Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ORS120A1180 ORS120A33 ORS230A150SD If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. SPDT DPDT Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: ORS X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 30s ─3 ─ - 0.6 - 60s ─4 ─ - 1.2 - 120s ─5 ─ - 3 - 300s X Output Form ─Blank ─ - SPDT ─D ─ - DPDT *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 300) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 300s in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Adjustable: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 70ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25W www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT or DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1x107; Electrical - 1x106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with four #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.7 oz (77 g) 59 Timer - Single Shot KRDS Series The KRDS Series is a compact time delay relay measuring only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRDS Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output relay energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Compact time delay relay •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±5% factory calibration •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 5 options Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRDS120 KRDS221 KRDS225 KRDS424 KRDS430 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed UTL = Untimed Load RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. A knob is supplied for adjustable units. The untimed load is optional. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: Order Table: KRDS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC/DC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . 110VDC, 120VAC or 230VAC . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Microcontroller with watchdog circuitry 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 40ms ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20%- 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature . . . . . -40° to 60°C/-40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot TDUS Series The TDUS Series combines digital timing circuitry with universal voltage operation. Voltages of 24 to 240VAC and 12 to 24VDC are available in three ranges. The TDUS Series offers DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1 seconds to 102.3 minutes in three ranges. Its 1A rated output, ability to operate on multiple voltages, and wide range of switch selectable time delays make the TDUS Series an excellent choice for process control systems and OEM equipment. Features: •Switch selectable time setting •0.1s - 102.3m in 3 ranges •± 0.5% repeat accuracy •± 2% setting accuracy •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated •Wide voltage ranges Approvals: Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TDUS3000A TDUS3002A TDUSL3000A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. UTL = Optional Untimed Load S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load Order Table: Input Voltage Range 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC Time Range 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m Part Number TDUSL3000A TDUSL3001A TDUSL3002A TDUS3000A TDUS3001A TDUS3002A TDUSH3000A TDUSH3001A TDUSH3002A Specifications Time Delay Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20 ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Input Voltage/Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC, 12 to 24VDC /±20% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed during timing Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1 mA Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 61 Timer - Single Shot TSDS Series The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance are required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. This product is suitable for many applications, including dispensing, welding, and exposure timing. Connection: (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) L1 N/L2 Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will not energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: L = Timed Load UTL = Optional Untimed Load S1 = Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •12VDC to 230VAC in 5 options •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSDS11390SP TSDS2110S TSDS320N TSDS321P TSDS421 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSDS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* X Switching Mode (VDC only) ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─P ─ - Positive ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─N ─ - Negative ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC ±15% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Solid state NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . DC Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA Positive or negative switching Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot THDS Series The THDS Series combines accurate timing circuitry with high power solid-state switching. It can switch motors, lamps, and heaters directly without a contactor. You can reduce labor, component cost, and increase reliability with these small, easy-to-use, Digi-Power timers. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output energizes if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Totally solid state and encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THDS230C THDS231C THDS232C THDS233C THDS234C THDS235C THDS410.25SA THDS411.5SA THDS414MC UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Timed Load S1 = Initiate Switch THDS420B THDS430C THDS432C THDS433C THDS434C THDS435C THDS610.25SA THDS611.5SA If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: THDS X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±2% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed during timing Output Steady State A 6A B 10A C 20A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Inrush** 60A 100A 200A Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC 100mA Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 63 Timer - Single Shot KSDS Series The KSDS Series is ideal for applications that require momentary start interval timing including dispensing, exposure timing, or pulse shaping. This series is available for both AC and DC voltages. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Connection: (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) L1 N/L2 Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will not energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. UTL = Optional Untimed Load L = Timed Load S1 = Initiate Switch External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •12 to 230V in 5 ranges •1A, solid-state output Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSDS1115SP KSDS121P KSDS130P KSDS310.1SP KSDS330P KSDS415M KSDS420 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: KSDS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Switching Mode (VDC only) ─P ─ - Positive ─N ─ - Negative *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±10% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10 % AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Solid state NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A Positive or negative switching Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Single Shot TSS Series The TSS is a totally solid-state timing module. Its 1A rated, solid-state output provides an excellent method of time control for exposures, dispensing, or for increasing or decreasing a switch closure. Time delays from 0.05 to 600 seconds, in 4 ranges, cover 90% of all OEM applications. Factory calibration of fixed delays is ±5% and the repeat accuracy is ±2%. The TSS can be surface mounted with a single screw, or snapped on a 35mm DIN rail using the P1023-20 accessory adaptor. Operation (Single Shot): Voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch opens. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Expands or decreases switch closures •Momentary or maintained initiate switch •Totally solid state •Encapsulated to protect against shock & vibration •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s in 4 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSS223 TSS410.5 TSS421 TSS422 S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load UTL = Optional Untimed Load TSS424 TSS432 TSS622 TSS624 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TSS X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05s - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed during timing www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals - 40° to 75°C / - 40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 65 Timer - Single Shot THC / THS Series The TH series is a solid-state relay and timer combined into one compact, easy-to-use control. When mounted to a metal surface, the TH Series may be used to directly control lamp or heater loads of up to 20A steady, 200A inrush. Its single shot function can perform dispensing and pulse shaping operations. The initiate switch can be a momentary or maintained type of switch. Time delays can be selected from 0.1 - 600 seconds in 4 ranges. The THC Series is used for coin vending applications where fast initiate response is required. Operation (Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch (leading edge triggered), the output energizes for a measured interval of time. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch opens. Loss of input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Features: •High load current capacity, up to 20A, 200A inrush •Momentary or maintained initiate switch •±2% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Fixed or adjustable 0.1 - 600s in 4 ranges •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THC41180B THC421C THS422B If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load UTL = Optional Untimed Load RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: THC / THS X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* X Output Rating ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 3s ─A ─ - 6A ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─B ─ - 10A ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─C ─ - 20A ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Currents 66 0.1 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 20ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±15% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed during timing Output Steady State A 6A B 10A C 20A Inrush** 60A 100A 200A Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA ≅ 2.5V at rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Retriggerable Single Shot HRD9 Series The HRD9 Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five ranges and factory fixed, external, or onboard adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The isolated output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. The HRD9 is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Motion Detector/Retriggerable Single Shot): Input voltage must be applied prior to and during timing. The output is de-energized. Upon closure of the initiate switch (momentary or maintained) the output energizes and the time delay starts. On completion of the delay period, the output de-energizes. Reset: Reclosing the initiate switch during or after timing will reset the time delay and restart timing. Reset is also accomplished by removing and reapplying input voltage. Note: Powering up the unit with the initiate switch closed will not energize the output relay or start timing. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Isolated, 30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •0.5% repeat timing accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Encapsulated circuitry Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: L1 HRD93110S HRD9320 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. N/L2 (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) External Resistance vs. Time Delay: S1 = Initiate Switch L = Timed Load UTL = Untimed Load (optional) NO = Normally Open C = Common, Transfer Contact NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are isolated. The untimed load is optional. Order Table: HRD9 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC Specifications X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . ±1%, ±5% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ±2% Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 20ms (≤ 1500 operations per min.) Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 230VAC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C/-40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 67 Timer - Retriggerable Single Shot KRD9 Series The KRD9 Series microcontroller timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Retriggerable Single Shot): Function Type A (Output Initially De-energized): Input voltage must be applied prior to and during timing. When the initiate switch is closed, (momentary or maintained) the output energizes and the time delay starts. On completion of the delay, the output de-energizes. The unit will time out if S1 remains in the open or closed position for the full time delay. Reclosing the initiate switch resets the time delay and restarts timing; the output remains energized. The output will not energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. Function Type B (Output Initially Energized): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the time delay starts. At the end of the time delay, the load de-energizes. The unit will time out if S1 remains in the open or closed position for the full time delay. Closing (re-closing) the initiate switch resets the time delay and restarts timing; the output remains energized. Reset: The time delay and the output are reset when input voltage is removed. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Compact time delay relay •Microcontroller circuitry •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 6 options Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRD9120B KRD92115MA KRD92115MB KRD9220B KRD93115MA KRD94115SB KRD9423B If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. C = Common, Transfer Contact UTL = Untimed Load (optional) A knob is supplied for adjustable units, or RT terminals 4 & 5 for external adjust. See external adjustment vs time delay chart. The untimed load is optional. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: Order Table: KRD9 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC/DC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Function Type ─A ─ - De-energized ─B ─ - Energized *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . 110VDC, 120 or 230VAC . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Microcontroller based with watchdog circuitry 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ 40ms; ≤ 750 operations per minute ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107 ; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reversed polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . -40°to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval TDI / TDIH / TDIL Series The TDI Series is an interval timer that combines accurate digital circuitry with isolated, 10A rated, DPDT relay contacts in an 8-pin plug-in package. The TDI Series features DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1 to 10,230 seconds in three ranges. The TDI Series is the product of choice for custom control panel and OEM designers. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output relay is energized during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. Connection: Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: Features: •Switch settable time delay •Three time ranges from 0.1s - 10,230s •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •10A, DPDT output contacts •LED indication Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: TDI120AL TDI12D TDI230AL TDI24AL TDI24DL TDIH24AL TDIL120AL TDIL24DL If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L1 N/L2 Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: TDI - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments TDIH - 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments TDIL - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments X Input Voltage ─12D ─ - 12VDC ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─24D ─ - 24VDC/28VDC ─110D ─ - 110VDC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X LED Indication* ─L ─ * Note: LED not available in 12VDC Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range**. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED glows during timing; relay is energized Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 3.25W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.4 x 1.8 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 65°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) ** For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 69 Timer - Interval HRDI Series The HRDI Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five ranges and factory fixed, external, or onboard adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. This series is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output relay is energized during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Encapsulated circuitry •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat timing accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRDI117S HRDI220 HRDI221 HRDI222 HRDI223 HRDI224 HRDI320 HRDI321 HRDI322 HRDI323 HRDI324 HRDI4130M HRDI421 HRDI422 HRDI423 HRDI424 HRDI431 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open L = Load NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RTT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are not isolated. Order Table: HRDI X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . ±1%, ±5% Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 230VAC. . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT, non-isolated Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 70 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval KRDI Series The KRDI Series is a compact time-delay relay measuring only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its solidstate timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRDI Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output relay energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Compact time delay relay •10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 6 options Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: KRDI1132S KRDI2110S KRDI120 KRDI21120S KRDI121 KRDI320 KRDI122 KRDI420 KRDI210.1S KRDI423 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed A knob is supplied for adjustable units, or RT terminals 4 & 5 for external adjust. See external adjustment vs time delay chart. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: Order Table: KRDI X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . 110VDC, 120VAC or 230VAC. . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Encapsulated ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) 71 Timer - Interval TDUI Series The TDUI Series combines digital timing circuitry with universal voltage operation. Voltages of 24 to 240VAC and 12 to 24VDC are available in three ranges. The TDUI Series offers DIP switch selectable time delays ranging from 0.1 seconds to 102.3 minutes in three ranges. Its 1A rated output, ability to operate on multiple voltages, and wide range of switch selectable time delays make the TDUI Series an excellent choice for process control systems and OEM equipment. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 Features: •Switch selectable time setting •0.1s - 102.3m in 3 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated •Wide voltage ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TDUI3000A TDUIH3001A TDUIH3002A TDUIL3002A Order Table: Input Voltage Range 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC 24 to 120VAC 100 to 240VAC 12 to 24VDC Time Range 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 0.1 - 102.3s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 1 - 1023s 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m 0.1 - 102.3m Part Number TDUIL3000A TDUIL3001A TDUIL3002A TDUI3000A TDUI3001A TDUI3002A TDUIH3000A TDUIH3001A TDUIH3002A Specifications Time Delay Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments Repeat Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 to 240VAC, 12 to 24VDC ±20% AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 10% Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed during timing Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A OFF State Leakage Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 72 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval TSD2 Series The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance are required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 100 hours are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is energized during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 100h •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Available Models: TSD2221 TSD241600S TSD2411S TSD2434 TSD24145S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TSD2 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 1 - 100h *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. or (1 - 100) (H) hours Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100h in 7 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±1% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weightv. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 73 Timer - Interval THD2 Series The THD2 Series combines accurate timing circuitry with high power solid-state switching. It can switch motors, lamps, and heaters directly without a contactor. You can reduce labor, component cost, and increase reliability with these small, easy-to-use, Digi-Power timers. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Totally solid state and encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THD2B4110M THD2B41600S THD2B6110M THD2C231 THD2C232 THD2C233 THD2C234 THD2C235 S1 = Optional Low Current Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. THD2C423 THD2C430 THD2C431 THD2C432 THD2C433 THD2C434 THD2C435 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: THD2 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (1 - 1000) followed by (S) secs. or (M) mins. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current 74 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±2% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state NO, closed during timing Output Steady State A 6A B 10A C 20A Inrush** 60A 100A 200A Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA ≅ 2.5V at rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval TSD6 Series The TSD6 offers total solid-state, interval timing for 12 or 24VDC applications. This series provides either negative or positive switching. The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 100 hours are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Connection: (Positive Switching) (Negative Switching) Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 100h •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •12 or 24VDC interval timing •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: TSD6113SN TSD6310.8SN TSD6121N TSD631180SP TSD6121P TSD631380SP TSD6123N TSD6320P TSD6124P TSD6334P If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSD6 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─3 ─ - 24VDC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 1 - 100h X Switching Mode ─P ─ - Positive ─N ─ - Negative *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. or (1 - 100) (H) hours Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100h 7 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±1% 12 or 24VDC ±15% ±10% ≤ 1W Solid state, positive or negative switching NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 1mA ≅ 1.0V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 75 Timer - Interval KSD2 Series The KSD2 Series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable, solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for input voltages of 24, 120 or 230VAC. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. An excellent choice for most OEM pulse shaping, maximum run time, and other process control applications. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSD2211M KSD2221 KSD2413M KSD2420 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: KSD2 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) secs. or (M) mins. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state NO, closed during timing 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Interval TS2 / TS6 Series The TS2 Series is designed for 24, 120 or 230VAC and the TS6 Series is designed for 12 or 24VDC. These series are capable of controlling load currents of up to 1A steady state, 10A inrush. Encapsulated circuitry and the reliability of a ±2% repeat accuracy make the TS2 and TS6 ideal for cost sensitive applications. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features: •12 or 24VDC; 24,120, or 230VAC input voltages •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05s - 10m in 8 ranges •Repeat accuracy ±2% •Load currents to 1A, 10A inrush •Totally solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) TS6 12VDC Time Delay 1 - 0.05-1s 2 - 0.5-20s 3 - 2-60s 4 - 5-120s VTP P/N VTP2A VTP2E VTP2F VTP2H TS2 & TS6 All Other Voltages Time Delay 1 - 0.05-3s 2 - 0.5-60s 3 - 2-180s 4 - 5-600s Available Models: Order Tables: TS6 X Input Voltage X Adjustment X Time Delay* ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. X Input Voltage X Adjustment X Time Delay* 12VDC 24VDC ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP5N Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Note: TS6 is not reverse polarity protected. TS2 VTP P/N ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 1s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 20s ─3 ─ - 2 - 60s ─4 ─ - 5 - 120s 0.05 - 3s 0.5 - 60s 2 - 180s 5 - 600s X Switching Mode ─P ─ - Positive TS22120 TS2421 TS6116P TS2213 TS2422 TS6122P TS2223 TS2423 TS6123P TS2411.5 TS2424 TS6311P TS24110 TS2611.5 TS63110P TS2412 TS26130 TS6321P TS2413 TS26190 TS24130 TS2621 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.05 - 120 12VDC) or (0.05 - 600 24VDC) in secs. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry Range 12VDC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 120s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed (1 MΩ max. RT ) Other Voltages . . . . . . . . 0.05 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±15% DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC ≤ 1W; AC ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed during timing Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC ≅ 1.0V @ 1A; AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TS6 is not reverse polarity protected Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 77 Timer - Interval TH2 Series The TH2 is the combination of a timer and a solidstate relay into one easy-to-use solid-state molded module. When mounted to a metal surface, the TH2 Series can switch load currents up to 20A steady state with 200A inrush. The TH2 replaces a timer and relay at a competitive price. Operation (Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output energizes during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Connection: L1 N/L2 Features •High load current capacity up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable time delays from 0.1 - 600s in 4 ranges •±2% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: TH2A421 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: TH2 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges, or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±5% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±15% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, closed during timing Maximum Load Currents Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A 78 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V at rated current OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling TDR Series The TDR Series of time-delay relays are comprised of digital circuitry and an isolated, 10A relay output. The on and off delays are selected by means of two, ten position binary switches, which allow the setting of the desired delay to be precise every time. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the green LED glows, the output relay is energized, the red LED glows, and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes, the red LED turns OFF and the T2, OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output relay energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the green LED glows, the T1 OFF time begins, the load is OFF. At the end of the OFF time, the T2 ON time begins, the load energizes, and the red LED glows. At the end of the ON time the load de-energizes and the red LED turns OFF. The cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 Relay contacts are isolated. Features: •Switch settable time delays - both times adjustable •0.1s - 2.84h in 3 ranges •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •Isolated, 10A, DPDT output contacts •Octal plug-in base connection Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: TDR1A22 TDR2A22 TDR2A23 TDR4A11 TDR4A12 TDR4A13 TDR4A22 TDR4A23 TDR4A33 TDR4B22 TDR4B23 TDR6A22 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: Order Table: TDR X Input Voltage X Sequence X ON Time ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC/DC ─A ─ - ON Time First ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in ─D ─ - 12* to 48VDC ─B ─ - OFF Time First 0.1s increments ─1 ─ - 12VDC* ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s in 1s ─2 ─ - 24VAC increments ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─3 ─ - 10 - 10,230s in ─4 ─ - 120VAC 10s increments ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC *Control status LED not available on 12VDC units. X OFF Time ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments ─3 ─ - 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range**. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 500ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 to 24VDC, 110VDC, 24, 120, or 230VAC; 24 to 240VAC/DC; 12 to 48VDC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Input LED Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Green; On when input voltage is applied Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 30VDC; 1/3 hp @ 230VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Relay LED Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Red; ON when output relay energizes Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) **For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 79 Timer - Recycling HRDR Series The HRDR Series combines an electromechanical relay and microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five ranges and factory fixed, onboard or externally adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The high switching capacity of the output contacts allow for direct control of heavy loads like compressors, pumps, motors, heaters and lighting. A bypass/ reset switch option allows operator to interrupt normal recycling sequence and energize output relay. An excellent choice for OEM applications. Operation (Recycling with Reset Switch): Upon application of input voltage, the ON time T1 begins and output relay energizes. At the end of the ON time, the output relay de-energizes and the OFF time T2 begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output relay energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Some recycling timers have the OFF time as the first delay. Reset: Removing input voltage resets output and time delays, and returns sequence to the first delay. Bypass/Reset Switch: Closing the normally open bypass/ reset switch energizes the output relay and resets the time delays. Opening the switch restarts recycling operation with the first delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Encapsulated circuitry •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •Independent adjustment of on and off delays •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRDR11720MB60S HRDR330A0R HRDR120A1R HRDR331A1 HRDR121A4R HRDR4110MB20M HRDR130A0R HRDR431A1R HRDR321A4R HRDR322B2R If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. NO = Normally Open S1 = Reset Switch C = Common, Transfer Contact L = Load Terminals 4 & 5 and/or 7 & 8 are only included on externally adjustable units. Relay contacts are non-isolated. RT is included when external adjustment is ordered. Terminal 6 is included when Bypass/Reset is selected. Order Table: HRDR X Input Voltage X External Adjust ─6─ - ON Time Onboard Adj. ─1─ - Both Times Fixed OFF Time Fixed ─1─ - 12VDC ─2─ - Both Times Onboard Adj. ─7─ - ON Time Fixed ─2─ - 24VAC ─3─ - Both Times External Adj. OFF Time Onboard Adj. ─3─ - 24VDC ─4─ - ON Time External Adj. ─8─ - ON Time Onboard Adj. OFF Time Fixed ─4─ - 120VAC OFF Time External Adj. ─6─ - 230VAC ─5─ - ON Time Fixed ─9─ - ON Time External Adj. OFF Time External Adj. OFF Time Onboard Adj. X T1 ON Time* ─0─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1─ - 1 - 100s ─2─ - 10 - 1000s ─3─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4─ - 1 - 100m ─5─ - 10 - 1000m X Operating Sequence X T2 OFF Time* X Operation ─0─ - 0.1 - 10s ─Blank ─ - NoBypass/ ─1─ - 1 - 100s Reset Option ─2─ - 10 - 1000s ─R ─ - Bypass/Reset ─3─ - 0.1 - 10m Option ─4─ - 1 - 100m ─5─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (0.1 - 1000) (M) min. ──A - ON time first ──B - OFF time first Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC. . . . . . 24 to 230VAC. . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings: General Purpose 125/240VAC Resistive 125/240VAC 28VDC Motor Load 125VAC 240VAC 80 100ms - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Electromechanical relay SPDT, non-isolated SPDT- NO 30A 30A 20A 1 hp* 2 hp** SPDT-NC 15A 15A 10A 1/4 hp** 1 hp** Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling HRD3 Series The HRD3 Series combines an electromechanical relay output with microcontroller timing circuitry. It offers 12 to 230V operation in five options and factory fixed, external, or onboard adjustable time delays with a repeat accuracy of ±0.5%. The output contact rating allows for direct operation of heavy loads, such as compressors, pumps, blower motors, heaters, etc. This series is ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output relay energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output relay energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2, OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1, ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of the ON time the load de-energizes, and the cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Equal on and off delays •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •12 to 230V operation in 5 options •Encapsulated •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRD3220A HRD3221A HRD3222A HRD3223A HRD3224A HRD3320A HRD3321A HRD3322A HRD3323A HRD3324A HRD3420A HRD3421A HRD3422A HRD3423A HRD342A0A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open L = Load NOTE: A knob, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Relay contacts are not isolated. Order Table: HRD3 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Tolerance ─Blank ─ - ±5% ─A ─ - ±1% X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON Time First ─B ─ - OFF Time First *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . ±1%, ±5% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC . . . . . . -15% - 20% 24 to 230VAC . . . . . . -20% - 10% Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated, SPDT Ratings: SPDT-NO SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** 6 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; 5 Electrical - 1 x 10 , *3 x 104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 81 Timer - Recycling ERD3 Series Econo-Timers are a combination of digital electronics and a reliable electromechanical relay. DPDT relay output for relay logic circuits, and isolation of input to output voltages. Cost effective for OEM applications, such as duty cycling, drying, washing, signaling, and flashing. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output relay energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output relay energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of the ON time the load de-energizes, and the cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 10 for dimensional drawing. Features •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •Encapsulated digital circuitry •Isolated, 10A, DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-16 P/N: P1004-16-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: ERD3425A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. A knob, or terminals 9 & 10 are only included on adjustable units. Relay contacts are isolated. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: ERD3 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 120VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 1s ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 5s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─4 ─ - 0.2 - 15s ─5 ─ - 0.3 - 30s ─6 ─ - 0.6 - 60s ─7 ─ - 0.1 - 5m ─8 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─9 ─ - 0.2 - 15m ─10 ─ - 0.3 - 30s ─11 ─ - 10 - 500m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON Time First ─B ─ - OFF Time First *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 500m in 11 adjustable ranges 0.1s - 1000m fixed Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knob, external adjust, or fixed Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, or 120VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120VAC/DC & 230VAC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated relay contacts 82 Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.7 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 43.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 65°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5.7 oz (162 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling KRDR Series The KRDR Series is a compact time-delay relay measuring only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its solidstate timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRDR Series is a cost effective recycling timer for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. •Compact time delay relay •10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed or onboard adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •Input voltages from 120 to 230V in 6 options •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration Approvals: Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output relay energizes and the T2 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T1 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output relay energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the time delays, and returns the sequence to the ON time. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T1 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T2 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of the ON time the load de-energizes, and the cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 Features: N/L2 Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. T1 = OFF Time T2 = ON Time NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common A knob is supplied for adjustable units. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: KRDR115MB25M KRDR321A4 KRDR120A0 KRDR321B4 KRDR123A4 KRDR421A4 KRDR124A4 KRDR424A0 KRDR320A1 KRDR440.5SA0 KRDR320B0 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: KRDR X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustments ─1 ─ - Both Times Fixed ─2 ─ - Both Times Adj. ─3 ─ - ON Time Adj. OFF Time Fixed ─4 ─ - ON Time Fixed OFF Time Adj. X T2 ON Time* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first X T1 OFF Time* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 999) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . 110VDC & 120 or 230VAC. . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5 % or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120 or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Encapsulated ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) 83 Timer - Recycling KRD3 Series The KRD3 Series measures only 2 in. (50.8 mm) square. Its solid-state timing circuit provides excellent repeat accuracy and stability. Encapsulation protects against shock, vibration, and humidity. The KRD3 Series is a cost effective approach for OEM applications that require small size, isolation, reliability, and long life. Operation (Recycling Flasher - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to T1 ON time. Operation (Recycling Flasher - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2 OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features •Compact time-delay relay •10A, SPDT output contacts •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Input voltages from 12 to 230V in 5 options Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KRD3110.4SA KRD31160SA KRD3420A KRD3434A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage C = Common, Transfer Contact NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed A knob is supplied for adjustable units, or RT terminals 4 & 5 for external adjust. See external adjustment vs time delay chart. Relay contacts are isolated. Output Current/Ambient Temperature: Order Table: KRD3 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard knob ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON Time First ─B ─ - OFF Time First *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec, or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . 110VDC, 120 or 230VAC . . . AC Line Frequency/DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating (at 40°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±5% 12, 24 or 110VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Isolated relay contacts SPDT 10A resistive @ 125VAC; 5A resistive @ 230VAC & 28VDC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC Max. Switching voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Life (Operations). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 Encapsulated ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling RS Series The RS Series is a solid-state, encapsulated, recycling timer designed for tough industrial environments. It is used by many testing labs as a life cycle tester; by others as a cycle controller. The RS Series has separate DIP switch adjustments for the on delay and the off delay. These make accurate adjustment possible the first time, every time. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1023 hours are available in 4 ranges. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First) Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the ON time. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First) Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Accurate, reliable, recycling timer •Switch settable time delays - both times adjustable •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±2% setting accuracy •0.1s - 1023h in 4 ranges •12 to 230V in 5 options •1A, solid-state output •Totally solid state and encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: RS1A11 RS1A12 RS1B12 RS2A12 RS2A24 RS2B44 RS4A11 RS4A12 RS4A13 RS4A22 RS4A24 RS4A31 RS4A33 RS4B23 RS6A13 RS6A24 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L = Load Order Table: RS X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first X T1 ON Time ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments ─3 ─ - 1 - 1023m in 1m increments ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023h in 1h increments X T2 OFF Time ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments ─2 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments ─3 ─ - 1 - 1023m in 1m increments ─4 ─ - 1 - 1023h in 1h increments Specifications Time Delay Range*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 0.1 - 102.3m in 0.1m increments 1 - 1023m in 1m increments 1 - 1023h in 1h increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . < ±2% or 20ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . < 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . < ± 2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / < ±10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC < 2VA; DC < 1W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 3 x 2 x 1.5 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) *For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. 85 Timer - Recycling ESDR Series The ESDR Series offers independent time adjustment of both delay periods. Adjustment options include fixed, onboard or external adjust. The ESDR is recommended for air drying, automatic oiling, life testing, chemical metering and automatic duty cycling. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable, solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is <±5%. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for input voltages of 12VDC to 230VAC in five ranges. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in six ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Connection: L1 Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes (Positive Switching) and the T1, ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, (Negative Switching) the output de-energizes and the T2, OFF time begins. At N/L2 the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. V = Voltage L = Load T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. A knob is supplied for adjustment on the unit; terminals for external adjustment. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features •ON/OFF recycling with independent adjustment of both the on and off periods •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •0.1s to 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.1% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •Available in AC or DC voltages Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: ESDR120A0P ESDR120A1P ESDR120A4P ESDR120B3P ESDR121A2P ESDR121A3P ESDR123A0P ESDR123B4P ESDR124A0P ESDR125A5P ESDR152B1P ESDR221A2 ESDR221B5 ESDR224B4 ESDR310.7SA10SP ESDR320A0P ESDR320A3P ESDR420A1 ESDR420A4 ESDR420B1 ESDR420B4 ESDR421A1 ESDR421A4 ESDR421B1 ESDR423A4 ESDR423B1 ESDR424A0 ESDR424A4 ESDR450A1 ESDR452B1 ESDR620B3 ESDR621A1 ESDR650A1 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: ESDR X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X External Adjust ─1 ─ - Both Times Fixed ─2 ─ - Both Times Onboard Adj. ─3 ─ - ON Time Onboard Adj. ── OFF Time Fixed ─4 ─ - ON Time Fixed OFF Time Onboard Adj. ─5 ─ - Both Times External Adj. ─6 ─ - ON Time External Adj. OFF Time Fixed ─7 ─ - ON Time Fixed OFF Time External Adj. ─8 ─ - ON Time Onboard Adj. OFF Time External Adj. ─9 ─ - ON Time External Adj. OFF Time Onboard Adj. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ± 5% ≤ ±2% ≤ 150ms 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Solid state 1A steady state , 10A inrush at 60°C X T1 ON Time* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first X T2 OFF Time* X Switching Mode ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s (VDC Only) ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─P ─ - Positive ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─N ─ - Negative ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ DC units are reverse polarity protected Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling Connection: L1 TSDR Series T h e T S D R D i g i - Ti m e r i s a n o n / o ff o r off/on recycling timing module designed to control metering pumps, chemical valves, flash lamps, or use in energy saving or duty cycling applications. It may be ordered with both time delays factory fixed, or one delay fixed and the other delay external or onboard adjustable. The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size and accurate performance are required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is < ±5%. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. N/L2 RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. An onboard adjustment, or terminals 4 & 5 are only included on adjustable units. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1, ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2, OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the T1 ON time. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of the T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2 OFF time. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Fixed or adjustable 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •± 0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSDR2150MA5M TSDR215SB18M TSDR410.1SA0.3S TSDR410.4SB4S TSDR412.5SA0.5S TSDR412.5SA4.5S TSDR4140MA20M TSDR415SB18M TSDR440.25SA1 TSDR4412SA1 TSDR442MA2 TSDR4430SA2 TSDR450.3SA1 TSDR6110SA30S TSDR612.5SA4.5S TSDR615SB18M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSDR X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Both Times Fixed ─2 ─ - ON Time Onboard Adj. OFF Time Fixed ─3 ─ - ON Time External Adj. OFF Time Fixed ─4 ─ - ON Time Fixed OFF Time External Adj. ─5 ─ - ON Time Fixed OFF Time Onboard Adj. X T1 ON Time* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X First Delay ─A ─ - ON time ─B ─ - OFF time X T2 OFF Time* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±5% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 87 Timer - Recycling KSDR Series The KSDR Series offers independent time adjustment of both delay periods. The KSDR is recommended for air drying, automatic oiling, life testing, chemical metering, and automatic duty cycling. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable, solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within ± 5% of the target delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for input voltages of 24, 120 or 230VAC. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Recycling - ON Time First) Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1, ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2, OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to T1 ON time. Operation (Recycling - OFF Time First) Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2 OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features •Adjustable 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSDR21A1 KSDR24A4 KSDR40A0 KSDR42A4 KSDR61A4 KSDR64A4 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Order Table: KSDR X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X T1 ON Time ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first X T2 OFF Time ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V @ 1A ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling Flasher THD3 Series The THD Series combines accurate timing circuitry with high power, solid-state switching. It can switch motors, lamps, and heaters directly without a contactor. The THD3 has equal on and off time delays. A single RT sets both time delays. You can reduce labor, component cost, and increase reliability with these small, easy-to-use, DigiPower timers. Operation (Recycling Flasher - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to T1 ON time. Operation (Recycling Flasher - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2 OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •High load currents up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •Metallized mounting surface for heat transfer •Totally solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: THD3C23A0 THD3C23A1 THD3C23A2 THD3C23A3 THD3C23A4 THD3C23A5 THD3C42A0 THD3C43A1 THD3C43A2 THD3C43A3 THD3C43A4 THD3C43A5 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Optional Low Current Initiate Switch RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: THD3 X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.5 - 1000) followed by (S) secs. or (M) mins. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single variable resistor changes both the on & off times equally Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±1% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Maximum Load Current Output Steady State Inrush** A 6A 60A B 10A 100A C 20A 200A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V at rated current OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting ** . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) **Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 89 Timer - Recycling Flasher TSD3 Series The TSD3 is a solid-state ON/OFF recycling timer with the on time always equal to the off time. When time delay is changed by the RT, both the ON and the OFF periods are changed. The TSD Series is designed for more demanding commercial and industrial applications where small size, and accurate performance is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 1% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1% of the time delay. The TSD Series is rated to operate over an extended temperature range. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 100 hours are available. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Recycling Falsher - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1, ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the T1 ON time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Features •Equal on and off delays •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s - 100h •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±1% factory calibration •24, 120, or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TSD3411S TSD34150S TSD36130M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TSD3 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m ─6 ─ - 1 - 100h *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. or (1 - 100) (H) hours Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 0.1s - 100h in 7 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±1% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±1% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Off State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Recycling Flasher KSD3 Series The KSD3 Digi-Timer is a cost effective approach for ON/OFF recycling applications. The on time is equal to the off time. An adjustment of the RT will change the time delays of both on and off times. This series is designed for general purpose commercial and industrial applications where a small, cost effective, reliable, solid-state timer is required. The factory calibration for fixed time delays is within 5% of the target time delay. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.5% of the selected time delay. This series is designed for popular AC and DC voltages. Time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes are available in 6 ranges. The output is rated 1A steady and 10A inrush. The modules are totally solid state and encapsulated to protect the electronic circuitry. Operation (Recycling Flasher - ON Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1, ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the ON time. Operation (Recycling Flasher - OFF Time First): Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of the ON time the load de-energizes, and the cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays and the sequence to the OFF time. Connection: L1 N/L2 RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.1s -1000m •Equal on and off delays •±0.5% repeat accuracy •± 5% factory calibration •12 to 120V in 4 ranges •1A, solid-state output •Encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KSD3120A KSD3310.1SA KSD3410.5SA KSD3432A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Order Table: KSD3 X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust ─3 ─ - Onboard adjust Note: DC voltages available in negative switching only X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X Operating Sequence ─A ─ - ON time first ─B ─ - OFF time first *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Specifications Time Delay Range.............................................................0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed Repeat Accuracy..........................................±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Tolerance (Factory Calibration).................≤ ± 5% Reset Time.....................................................≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage.................≤ ±10% Input Voltage...........................................................24 or 120VAC; 12 or 24VDC Tolerance.......................................................±20% AC Line Frequency......................................50/60 Hz Power Consumption...................................AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 1W Output Type...............................................................Solid state Maximum Load Current.............................1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C OFF State Leakage Current........................AC ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC; DC ≅ 1mA www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Drop.................................................AC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A; DC ≅ 1V @ 1A DC Operation...............................................Negative switching only Protection Circuitry........................................................Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown..................................≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance...................................≥ 100 MΩ Polarity..........................................................DC units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting......................................................Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions...................................................2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination...................................................0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature...............-40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity.......................................................95% relative, non-condensing Weight............................................................≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 91 Timer - Percentage PTHF Series The PTHF Series can be used for a variety of applications from chemical metering, to temperature regulating, to energy management. The infinite adjustability from 1 to 99% provides accurate percentage on control over a wide factory fixed cycle period. When mounted on a metal surface, it can be used to drive solenoids, contactors, relays, or lamps, up to 20A steady, 200A inrush. PTHF is the suggested replacement for the PT Series. Operation (Percentage): Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the T1 ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Increasing the ON time decreases the OFF time. The total cycle period is equal to the ON time plus the OFF time. The total cycle period is factory fixed. ON time range is 1 to 99 percent of cycle period. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the T1 ON time. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Features •ON/OFF recycling percentage control •Controls loads up to 20A, 200A inrush •Fixed cycle period 10s - 1000m •±0.5% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Totally solid state & encapsulated •Onboard or external adjustment 1 - 99% ON Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 Available Models: PTHF410C PTHF410CK PTHF4120D PTHF615A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT = 100 KΩ S1 = Optional Low Current Initiate Switch T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Order Table: PTHF X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Fixed Cycle Period ─Specify ─ 10 - 1000 as the total fixed cycle period in seconds. If cycle period is in minutes insert (M) suffix. X Output Rating ─A ─ - 6A ─B ─ - 10A ─C ─ - 20A ─D ─ - 1A X Adjustment ─Blank ─ - External adjust ─K ─ - Onboard adjust Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External or onboard knob Range/External Adjustment Resistance. . . Adjustable from 1 - 99% / RT = 100 KΩ Cycle Period. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed from 10s - 1000m Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater Cycle Period Tolerance (Factory Calibration) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ± 5% Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 2VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Maximum Load Currents Output Steady State Inrush* Minimum A 6A 60A 100mA B 10A 100A 100mA C 20A 200A 100mA D 1A 10A -- 92 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting *. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.5V at rated current ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing 1A unit: ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g); 6, 10, 20A units: ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) *Units rated ≥ 6A must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Sequencing SQ Series The SQ Series is available with either three (SQ3) or four (SQ4) outputs and an adjustable or fixed time delay. The time delay period is the same for each output. This makes the SQ ideal for applications like dust collection, automatic lubrication, air drying, lighting displays, merchandising displays, duty cycling, and energy management. Operation (Sequencing): Upon application of input voltage, Load 1 energizes for the selected ON time delay. At the end of this ON time delay, Load 1 de-energizes and Load 2 immediately energizes starting another ON time delay. At the end of this ON time delay, Load 2 de-energizes and Load 3 immediately energizes. At the end of the ON time delay for Load 3 (Load 4 for 4 output devices), Load 1 reenergizes and the cycle repeats. The sequential operation continues as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing and re-applying input voltage resets the sequence to the Load 1 ON time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 166, Figure 14 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Three or four outputs •Variable delays from 0.1s - 100m in 5 ranges •Totally solid state for a long, reliable life •Encapsulated to protect against the environment •Digital circuitry for accuracy and stability •1A, solid-state outputs Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay 0 - 0.1-10s 1 - 1-100s 2 - 10-1000s 3 - 0.1-10m 4 - 1-100m VTP P/N VTP4C VTP4G VTP4K VTP45N VTP4P Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Available Models: RT is 3 megohms, when external adjustment is ordered. SQ4 shown; for SQ3, terminal 6 & load L4 are eliminated. SQ3221 SQ4424 SQ4434 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: SQ X # of Outputs ─3 ─ - Three ─4 ─ - Four X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - Onboard adjust ─3 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (1 - 100) (M) min Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop (Each Output). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital integrated circuitry 0.1s - 100m in 5 adjustable ranges or fixed ±1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±10% ≤ ±10% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state SPST NO (three or four) 1A steady state, 10A inrush per output ≅ 1.5V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.22 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 31 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 5.4 oz (153 g) 93 Timer - Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break The TDMB combines both delay-on-make and delay-on-break functions into one plug-in package. Selection of the time period is accomplished with dual switches, one for the on delay and the other for the off delay. SPDT or DPDT output options provide isolated, 10A switching capability. Operation (Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break): Input voltage must be applied at all times. The output relay is de-energized. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the green LED glows and the delay-on-make time delay (T1) begins. At the end of T1, the output relay energizes and the red LED glows. When the initiate switch opens, the green LED turns OFF and the delay-on-break time delay (T2) begins. At the end of T2, the output relay deenergizes and the red LED turns OFF. Reset: Removing input voltage resets time delay and output. Opening the initiate switch during the delay-onmake delay, resets T1. Closing the initiate switch during the delay-on-break delay, resets T2. Connection: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. 8-pin octal SPDT L1 Digi-Set Binary Switch Operation: TDMB Series Features •Switch settable time delays from 0.1s - 10,230s in 3 ranges •±2% setting accuracy •±0.1% repeat accuracy •10A, SPDT or DPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) Available Models: TDMB411 TDMB422 TDMB411D TDMB422D TDMB413D TDMB622 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. N/L2 11-pin DPDT (P/N ends with D) L1 N/L2 Relay contacts are isolated. Order Table: TDMB X Input Voltage X Delay-on-Make ─A ─ - 24 to 240VAC/DC ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in ─D ─ - 12 to 48VDC 0.1s increments ─1 ─ - 12VDC* ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s in 1s ─2 ─ - 24VAC increments ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─3 ─ - 10 - 10230s in ─4 ─ - 120VAC 10s increments ─5 ─ - 110VDC ─6 ─ - 230VAC *No control status LED for 12VDC X Delay-on-Break ─1 ─ - 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments ─2 ─ - 1 - 1023s in 1s increments ─3 ─ - 10 - 10230s in 10s increments X Type Plug/Output Form ─Blank ─ - Octal plug (8-pin) SPDT ─D ─ - 11-pin plug DPDT Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller circuitry Range**. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 - 102.3s in 0.1s increments 1 - 1023s in 1s increments 10 - 10,230s in 10s increments Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% or 50ms, whichever is greater Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 150ms Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Control LED Indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Green; on when the initiate switch is closed Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC; 24 to 240VAC/DC; 12 to 48VDC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . . . . -15% - 20% 110 to 230VAC/DC . . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC ≤ 2VA; DC ≤ 2W Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT or DPDT 94 Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 230VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x107; Electrical - 1 x 10 5 Max. Switching Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Relay LED Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Red; on when output relay energizes (not included on 12VDC units) Protection Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100M Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DC units are reverse polarity protected Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.4 x 1.8 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in, magnal 11-pin plug-in Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -30° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) ** For CE approved applications, power must be removed from the unit when a switch position is changed. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delayed Interval ESD5 Series The ESD5 Series is an accurate, solid-state, delayed interval timer. It offers a 1A steady, 10A inrush output and is available with adjustable or fixed time delays of 0.1 seconds to 1000 minutes in six ranges. Input voltages of 24, 120, or 230VAC are available. Encapsulation offers protection against shock and vibration. Adjustment options are factory fixed, onboard or externally adjustable. The repeat accuracy, under stable conditions, is 0.1%. The factory calibration of the time delay is ± 5%. Operation (Delayed Interval): Upon application of input voltage, the T1 delay-on-make time delay begins and the output remains de-energized. At the end of this delay, the output energizes and the T2 interval delay begins. At the end of the interval delay period, the output de-energizes. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 External Resistance vs. Time Delay: Features: •Delay-on-Make with interval output •0.1s - 1000m in 6 ranges •±0.1% repeat accuracy •±5% factory calibration •Factory fixed, onboard or external adjust •Totally solid state & encapsulated •24, 120 or 230VAC •1A, solid-state output Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-95 P/N: P1004-95-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: ESD52233 ESD54160S2S ESD54233 ESD54500 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. RT is the external adjustment component. Note: Terminals 4, 5 and/or 7, 8 are included when external adjustment is ordered. A knob is included when onboard adjust is ordered. Order Table: ESD5 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Both Times Fixed ─2 ─ - Both Times External Adj. ─3 ─ - T1 Fixed, T2 External Adj. ─4 ─ - T1 External Adj., T2 Fixed ─5 ─ - Both Times Onboard Adj. ─6 ─ - T1 Fixed, T2 Onboard Adj. ─7 ─ - T1 External Adj., T2 Onboard Adj. ─8 ─ - T1 Onboard Adj., T2 Fixed ─9 ─ - T1 Onboard Adj., T2 External Adj. Specifications Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF State Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1s - 1000m in 6 adjustable ranges or fixed ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±2% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz ≤ 2VA Solid state 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≅ 5mA @ 230VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 1A www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 X T1 Delay-on-Make* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m X T2 Interval* ─0 ─ - 0.1 - 10s ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m ─5 ─ - 10 - 1000m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (M) min. Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68g) 95 Timer - Delay-on-Make TAC1 Series The TAC1 Series was designed to delay the operation of a compressor relay. It eliminates the possibility of relay chatter due to half-wave failure of the output. It connects in series with the load relay coil and provides a delay-on-make time delay each time input voltage is applied. It can be used for random start, anti-short cycling, sequencing, and many other applications. It is an excellent choice for all air conditioning and refrigeration equipment. Operation (Delay-on-Make): Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. Connection: L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. N/L2 Features •UL approved for air conditioning & refrigeration equipment •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s •24 to 230VAC •Fail-safe design eliminates contactor chatter problems •±2% repeat accuracy Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-XX P/N: P1004-XX-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay 1 - 0.05-3s 2 - 0.5-60s 3 - 2-180s 4 - 5-600s Load may be connected to terminals 3 or 1. RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. VTP P/N VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP5N Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. Available Models: TAC1223 TAC1413 TAC1411 TAC14164 TAC141150 TAC1412 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TAC1 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─4 ─ - 5 - 600s delay (0.05 - 600) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Recycle Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog circuitry 0.05 - 600s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% ±20% ≤ 20ms after timing, during timing - 0.1% of time delay or 75ms, whichever is greater Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . ≤ ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO, open during timing Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C 96 Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 & 230VAC: ≅ 4.2V @ 0.5A 24VAC: ≅ 2.5V @ 0.5A Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 80°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Lockout T2D Series The T2D Series provides protection against short cycling of compressors and other motors. At the end of each operation, a lockout delay prevents restarting the compressor or motor until the delay is completed. 24VAC models can be used with thermostats that include a cooling anticipator resistor. It can be connected in series with the load for delay-on-make operation. Operation (Lockout with Random Start): Connection #1: Upon application of input voltage, a random start time delay begins. At the end of this time delay, the output is energized. Lockout Delay: Input voltage must be applied prior to and during timing. When the thermostat or initiate switch opens, the output de-energizes and the lockout time delay begins. At the end of the lockout delay, the output is energized allowing the load to immediately energize when the initiate switch or thermostat closes. Connection #2: Upon application of input voltage and closure of initiate switch, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the output is energized and remains energized until power is removed. Reset: Removing power resets the output and the time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 1 Random Start Plus Lockout L1 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features: •Lockout delay prevents rapid recycling of compressor •Random start delay helps prevent low voltage starting •Delay-on-make timer optional two terminal series connection •Totally solid-state 1A output •24VAC to 230VAC in 2 ranges Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: T2D120A1150S T2D120A15M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. N/L2 2 Delay-on-Make V = Voltage L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch or Thermostat Order Table: T2D X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─120A ─ - 120/230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 1 - 100s ─2 ─ - 10 - 1000s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 10m ─4 ─ - 1 - 100m *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (1 - 1000) followed by (S) sec. or (0.1 - 100) (M) min. Specifications Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lockout & Random Start Delays. . . . . . . . . . . 24VAC, or 120/230VAC in 2 ranges ±20% 50/60 Hz 24VAC - 100mA; 120/230VAC - 40mA 1A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C ≅ 2.5V @ 1A After timing - 16ms Analog circuitry 1s - 100m in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed Note: The lockout & random start delays are the same length. Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable: ±30%; factory fixed: ±30% Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±1% or 20ms, whichever is greater www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . After timing - ≤ 16ms; During timing - ≤ 200ms Protection Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) Cooling Anticipator (24VAC Units Only) Minimum Cooling Anticipator . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 3,000 Ω 97 Timer - Bypass TAC4 Series The TAC4 is a bypass timer that provides a closure across the low-pressure switch during compressor startup. Its time-delay circuit is totally solid state including the normally closed output. The molded housing with encapsulation, the single hole mounting, and 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) termination makes the TAC4 easy to use, rugged, and reliable. Operation (Bypass Timer): (As shown in the connection & function diagrams) Upon application of input voltage and closure of controller contact, CC, the load, CR, energizes and the time delay begins. During the time delay, the TAC4’s solid-state output bypasses the LPC, low pressure cutout switch. This allows the compressor controlled by CR to start and establish acceptable pressure. At the end of the time delay, TAC4’s output de-energizes and remains de-energized until reset. The TAC4 may be used in other applications where a controlling contact must be bypassed for a specified period of time. Reset: Removing input voltage or opening CC resets the output and time delay. Connection: L1 N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features •UL approved for air conditioning & refrigeration equipment •Fixed or adjustable delays from 0.05 - 600s •24, 120 or 230VAC •Fail-safe design eliminates contactor chatter problems •±2% repeat accuracy Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • External adjust potentiometer: P/N: P1004-12 P/N: P1004-12-X • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • Plug-on adjustment module: P/N: VTP(X)(X) Time Delay 1 - 0.05-3s 2 - 0.5-60s 3 - 2-180s 4 - 5-300s VTP P/N VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP5T Selection Table for VTP Plug-on Adjustment Accessory. V = Voltage LR = Lockout Relay OL = Overload or High Pressure Switch LPC = Low Pressure Cutout CR = Compressor Control Relay CC = Controller Contact RT is used when external adjustment is ordered. Available Models: TAC42110 TAC441120 TAC4415 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TAC4 X Input Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Adjustment ─1 ─ - Fixed ─2 ─ - External adjust X Time Delay* ─1 ─ - 0.05 - 3s ─2 ─ - 0.5 - 60s ─3 ─ - 2 - 180s *If fixed delay is selected, insert ─4 ─ - 5 - 300s delay (0.05 - 300) in seconds. Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Analog circuitry 0.05 - 300s in 4 adjustable ranges or fixed ±2% ±20% ≤±10% ≤ 150ms 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% 50/60 Hz Solid state NC, closed during timing 0.5A steady state, 10A inrush at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 & 230VAC ≅ 4.2V @ 0.5A 24VAC ≅ 2.5V @ 0.5A Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -40° to 75°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Lockout TA Series Connection: L1 N The TA Series prevents rapid recycling of a compressor. A lockout delay is started when the thermostat opens, or input voltage is lost. Eliminates tripped circuit breakers or blown fuses caused by a locked rotor during short cycling. The TA will not allow the compressor to start when the line voltage is low. Chatter of the compressor relay is eliminated. Because of the fast initiate time, bounce of the thermostat will not be transmitted to the compressor relay coil. A 30 second delay provides anti-reversing protection for scroll compressors. Features: Operation (Lockout): On initial closure of the S1, the compressor relay energizes immediately. When S1 opens or input voltage is interrupted, a lockout time delay is initiated. During this lockout time delay, the compressor relay cannot be energized. The low voltage (brownout) protection prevents energization of the compressor when the line voltage is low. Reset: The lockout time delay cannot be reset. After the time delay is completed, the unit automatically resets. Auxiliary Products: For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. •Ideal for HVAC/R applications •Lockout delay prevents rapid recycling of a compressor •Low voltage brownout protection •Circuitry to activate the cooling anticipator (24VAC models) •Eliminates nuisance service calls due to blown fuse or tripped breakers Approvals: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TA12D2 TA24A0.5 TA24A3 TA24A5 TA24D0.5 TA24D2 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. S1 = Initiate Switch, Contact, or Thermostat CR = Compressor Relay (Load) CA = Optional Cooling Anticipator V = Voltage Order Table: Input Voltage 24VAC 24VAC 24VAC 24VAC 12VDC 12VDC 24VDC 24VDC 24VDC 24VDC Time Delay 30s 2m 3m 5m 1m 2m 30s 2m 3m 5m Part Number TA24A0.5 TA24A2 TA24A3 TA24A5 TA12D1 TA12D2 TA24D0.5 TA24D2 TA24D3 TA24D5 Specifications Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 or 24VDC; 24VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Impedance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450 Ω (anticipator by-pass) Output Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75mA Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A at 60°C Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 1.25V Time Delay Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 16ms Lockout Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed 0.5, 1, 2, 3, or 5m Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . -15% - 35% Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Low Voltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 20V: 24VAC/DC; ≅ 9V: 12VDC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40° to 70°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) Thermostat Cooling Anticipator Resistor. . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1800 Ω 99 Timer - Lockout TL Series The TL Series provides protection against short cycling of a compressor. At the end of each operation, or whenever power is lost, a lockout delay is initiated. This lockout delay prevents restarting of the compressor until the head pressure has equalized. Compressor relay chatter due to thermostat bounce is eliminated by use of optional one second delay-on-make. The TL Series should not be used with cooling anticipator resistors or solid-state switches. (See the TA Series). Connection: L1 Operation (Lockout): Lockout: On initial closure of S1, the compressor relay energizes immediately (or after an optional 1 s delay). When the S1 opens or input voltage is interrupted, the output opens and remains open for the lockout time delay. During this lockout time delay period, the compressor relay cannot be re-energized. Reset: The lockout time delay cannot be reset. After the time delay is completed, the unit automatically resets. N/L2 For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Features •Ideal for HVAC/R applications •Lockout delay prevents short cycling of a compressor •Optional 1s delay-on-make prevents contactor chatter •Totally solid state and encapsulated •24VAC to 230VAC in 3 ranges •Eliminates nuisance service calls due to blown fuse or tripped breakers Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TL120A5T TL230A5 TL230A5T TL24A5 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch CR = Compressor or Control Relay Order Table: TL X Input Voltage ─24A ─ - 24VAC ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Lockout Time ─2 ─ - 2m ─3 ─ - 3m ─5 ─ - 5m X Delay-on-Make ─Blank ─ - No delay ─T ─ - 1s Specifications Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . Inrush Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay Initiate Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lockout Time* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Option. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 24, 120, or 230VAC 50/60 Hz ±20% ≤ 40mA 1A @ 24VAC; 0.5A @ 120 & 230VAC at 60°C 10A at 60°C 24VAC - 2.5V @ 1A 120 & 230VAC - 4.2V @ 0.5A ≅ 8ms Fixed 2, 3, or 5m -15% - 35% 1s delay-on-make eliminates contactor chatter due to thermostat bounce Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 70°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) *Power must be applied for at least 15 s to achieve a full lockout delay. Less than 15s will result in proportionally shorter delay periods. NOTE: Cooling anticipator resistor or leakage may cause erratic operation. See TA Series for use with 24VAC systems that include anticipator resistors or use solid-state switches. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Timer - Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break The CT Series combines a delay-on-make and delay-on-break time delay into one unit and may be used to control fan delays in heating and/or cooling equipment. The CT includes bypass circuitry to allow it to operate with cooling anticipators ≥ 3000 ohms. It is designed to operate in 24VAC control circuits. Several CT modules may be combined to provide sequencing on of any number of loads and sequencing off of the same loads, such as electric heating elements. Operation (Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break): Forced Air Heating or Air Conditioning (as shown): When the thermostat closes, the compressor relay is immediately energized. At the end of a fixed delay-on-make delay (T1), the fan relay is energized. When the thermostat opens, the compressor relay is de-energized and the delayon-break delay is initiated. On completion of the fixed delay-on- break delay (T2) the fan relay is de-energized. If the thermostat is reclosed during the delay-on-break delay, the delay-on-break delay is reset and the fan relay remains energized. If the thermostat is closed when input voltage is applied, the delay-on-make delay (T1) begins as normal. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays. Connection: L1 N For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Function: CR = Compressor Relay THMS = Wall Thermostat Delay-on-Make Delay-on-Break CT Series Features: •Delay-on-make and delay-on-break in one unit •Use for fan delays in heating or cooling equipment •Use for multiple load sequencing •24VAC operation •Factory fixed delays from 1 - 600s in 1s increments Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: CT1S12 CT1S30 CT1S300 CT1S45 CT1S8 CT1S90 CT30S1 CT45S45 CT5S300 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. V = Voltage R = Reset FS = Fan Switch FR = Fan Relay T1 = Delay-on-Make T2 = Delay-on-Break Order Table: CT X Delay-on-Make (fixed) ─Specify ─ time in seconds from 1 - 600s followed by (S) X Delay-on-Break (fixed) ─Specify ─ time in seconds from 1 - 600s Specifications Time Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . . Recycle Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Microcontroller 1 - 600s ±5% ±20% ≤ 300ms 24VAC ±15% 50/60 Hz Solid state NO 0.75A steady state, 5A inrush at 55°C ≅ 1.25V www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thermostat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 70°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) Anticipator Resistor: ≥ 3000 Ω 101 Timer - Vending HRV Series The HRV combines the accuracy of microcontroller based circuitry with an electromechanical relay output. The HRV’s switching capacity allows direct control of loads like compressors, pumps, motors, heaters, and lighting. The HRV “S” version provides a vend time after the selected number of initiate switch closures to start is reached. The HRV “A” version includes all of the “S” features and allows the total vend time to be extended for each additional initiate switch closure. The HRV is ideal for cost sensitive single coin or token vending machines. The electronic circuitry is encapsulated to protect against humidity and vibration. Connection: L1 N/L2 Isolated Output L1 N/L2 Non-Isolated Output Operation Coin Totalizer & Vending Timer (“S” Version): Input voltage must be applied prior to & during operation. When the total number of S1 initiate switch closures equals the number to start set on the lower 3 DIP switches, the load energizes and the vending time set on the upper 7 DIP switches begins. At the end of the vending time, the load de-energizes and the vending time is reset. Closing the initiate switch during vend timing will have no affect on vend time delay. Accumulating Vending Timer (“A” Version): Input voltage must be applied prior to & during operation. When the total number of S1 initiate switch closures equals the number to start set on the lower 3 DIP switches, the load energizes and the vending time starts. For every initiate switch closure, the HRV unit adds one time per coin period, as set on the upper 7 DIP switches, to the total vending time. Operation Note: If S1 is closed when input voltage is applied, the output remains de-energized and the S1 counter remains at zero closures. At least one “vend time” and one “closures to start” DIP switch must be in the “ON” position for proper operation. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the vend time delay, the S1 closure counter, and de-energizes the output relay. For more information see: Appendix A, pages 156-164 for function descriptions and diagrams. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch L = Load UTL = Optional Untimed Load Features •Accumulates 1 - 256 coins •Switch selectable 1 - 7 coins to start •Vend time from 1s - 31.75m •Coin switch can be connected to a counter •Up to 30A, 1 Hp at 125VAC, NO contacts •Encapsulated circuitry Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HRV11SC HRV24AC HRV31AC HRV31SC HRV41AE HRV41SC HRV41SE HRV42SE HRV43AE HRV43AN If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Switch Adjustment Combine upper seven switches in “ON” position for vend time in minutes. Combine lower three switches in “ON” position for number of closures to start. Order Table: HRV X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Vend Time ─1 ─ - 1 - 127s ─2 ─ - 5 - 635s ─3 ─ - 0.1 - 12.7m ─4 ─ - 0.25 - 31.75m X Mode of Operation ─S ─ - Coin totalizer vending timer ─A ─ - Accumulating vending timer X Output Form & Rating ─C ─ - 30A SPDT - NO (Isolated) ─E ─ - 30A SPDT - NO (Isolated) ─N ─ - 30A SPDT - NO (Non-Isolated) Specifications Count Functions/Switch Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Switch Closure Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Min. Switch Open (between closures) Time . . . . Count Range to start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Counts (“A” Version). . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay/Range ***. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . . . . . . 120 & 230 VAC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency / DC Ripple. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical (counts on switch closure) ≥ 20ms ≥ 20ms 1 - 7 counts 250 Adjustable 1s - 31.75m in 4 ranges 7 of a 10 position DIP switch 0% to +2% or 50ms, whichever is greater ±0.1% or 20ms, whichever is greater ≤ 150ms ≤ ±2% 12 or 24VDC; 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60 Hz / ≤ 10% AC ≤ 4VA; DC ≤ 2W Electromechanical relay Isolated, SPDT or non-isolated, SPDT Ratings: General Purpose Resistive SPDT-NO SPDT-NC 125/240VAC 30A 15A 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x 104, ** 6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output on isolated units Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . -40° to 70°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) ***For CE approved applications, voltage must be removed when a switch position is changed. 102 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Series Included Solid State FSU1000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FS126, FS127, FS146, FS147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FS143, FS152, FS162. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FS200. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FS300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FS400. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 104 105 105 106 106 107 Relay FS500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Chasers Flashers SC3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 SC4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 103 Flashers FSU1000 / FS100 Series The FSU1000 incorporates an onboard adjustable flash rate of 10 to 100 FPM and a universal input voltage in one device. Its circuitry is encapsulated and is capable of controlling loads of up to 20A. The versatility of the FSU1000 makes it ideal for applications where various flash rates and operating voltages are required. Operation When input voltage is applied to terminal 2 and the load (lamp), the load energizes steadily. When input voltage is applied to terminal 3, the output flashes. Optional Low Current Switch (S1) This low current switch could be a limit switch or contact. While open, the operator sees the load (lamp) ON and operating. When the limit switch closes, the load (lamp) flashes to attract attention. Order Table: Rating 1A 6A 10A 20A Inrush Rating 10A 60A 100A 200A Part Number FSU1000 FSU1003 FSU1004 FSU1005 For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (NC) function. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 1 for connection diagram. Features: •All solid state – no moving parts or contacts •Onboard adjustable flash rate •Loads up to 20A •High inrush up to 200A •Universal voltage 24 to 240VAC Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Available Models: FSU1000 FSU1003 FSU1004 Specifications Technical Data Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Range/Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF recycling solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Adjustable 10 - 100 FPM ≅ 50% 24 to 240VAC/50/60Hz Inductive, resistive, or incandescent 1, 6, 10, or 20A steady state 10 times steady state current Mechanical Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operation Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2. Output Rating Specifications 1A 1A 2A 1A 1A 2A Technical Data Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Custom Flash Rates Available. . . . ON/OFF Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 -20° to 60°C (240VAC +50°C) / -40° to 85°C 1A units: ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) > 6A units: ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) Features: •Fixed flash rate 75 FPM •Custom flash rate 45 - 150 FPM •1 or 2A output •24 or 120VAC •Small size: 1.5 x 0.94 in. (38 x 23.9 mm) Approvals: Available Models: FS126 FS126-45 FS126-60 FS126RC FS126RC-90 FS127 FS146 FS146RC For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (OFF First) function. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 12 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 2 for connection diagram. Order Table: Input Encapsulated *Units rated > 6A must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. The FS100 Series (low amp) may be used to control inductive, incandescent or resistive loads. This series offers a 1A (fullwave) or a 2A (halfwave) steady state, 10A inrush solid-state output and may be ordered with an input voltage of 24 or 120VAC. The FS100 Series offers a factory fixed flash rate of 75 FPM or may be ordered with a fixed, custom flash rate ranging from 45 to 150 FPM. Ideal for OEM applications where cost is a factor. 120VAC 120VAC 120VAC 24VAC 24VAC 24VAC Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Output Type AC, Fullwave AC, Fullwave AC, Halfwave AC, Fullwave AC, Fullwave AC, Halfwave Load Type* A B A A B A OFF/ON solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Factory fixed at 75 FPM ±20% From 45 - 150 FPM ±20% ≅ 50% 24, 120VAC, ±15% 50/60Hz Fullwave AC or Halfwave rectified AC Incandescent, resistive, or inductive (Choose RC suffix for inductive loads) Part Number FS126 FS126RC FS127 FS146 FS146RC FS147 *Load Type: A-Incandescent & Resistive B-Incandescent, Resistive & Inductive Add the suffix “-##” to any part number to indicate the custom flash rate. Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . Fullwave: 1A steady state Halfwave: 2A steady state Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removable mounting bracket, use one #8 (M4 x 0.7) screw Connection/Wires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 AWG (0.82mm2) wires 6 in. (15.2cm) Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 x 0.94 in. (38.1 x 23.9 mm) Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.-20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 1.1 oz (31 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Flashers FS100 / FS200 Series The FS100 Series (medium amp) may be used to control inductive, incandescent, or resistive loads. Input voltages of 24, 120, or 230VAC are available. Factory fixed flash rate of 90 FPM or may be ordered with a fixed, custom flash rate ranging from 10 to 300 FPM. Encapsulation provides protection against shock, vibration, and humidity. This group of solid-state flashers has proven reliability with years of use throughout the world. Operation Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2. Order Table: Input Voltage Rating Part Number 24VAC 3A FS143 120VAC 3A FS152 230VAC 3A FS162 Add the suffix “-##” to any part number to indicate the custom flash rate. For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (OFF First) function. Appendix B, page, 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page168, Figure 3 for connection diagram. Specifications Technical Data Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Custom Flash Rates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage/Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF/ON solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Fixed at 90 FPM ±10% 10 - 300 FPM ±10% ≅ 50% 24, 120, or 230VAC ±15%/50/60 Hz Inductive, resistive, or incandescent Fullwave AC, solid state, SPST Operation Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2. Input Voltage 12VDC ±20% 24VDC ±20% 36VDC ±20% 48VDC ±15% 110VDC ±15% For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (OFF First) function. Appendix B, page, 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 4 for connection diagram. Specifications Rating 3A 3A 1A 0.75A 0.25A Part Number FS219 FS224 FS236 FS248 FS290 Technical Data Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .OFF/ON solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed at 90 FPM ±10% Custom Flash Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 180 FPM ON/OFF Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 50% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 24, 36, 48, or 110VDC Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inductive, resistive, or incandescent Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 - 3A steady state OFF State Leakage Current 12 & 24VDC. . . . . . . . . . ≤ 250 µA www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 •Fixed at 90 FPM •Custom flash rate 10 - 300 FPM •Switches inrush currents up to 30A •24, 120, or 230VAC input voltages •Totally solid state & encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: FS143 FS152-60 FS152 FS162 FS152-30 FS162-30 FS152-50 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The FS200 Series may be used to control inductive, incandescent, or resistive loads. Input voltages of 12, 24, 36, 48, or 110VDC are available. Factory fixed flash rate of 90 FPM or may be ordered with a fixed custom flash rate ranging from 10 to 180 FPM. Encapsulation provides protection against shock, vibration, and humidity. Uniform performance, high inrush current capability, and low RFI, make this series ideal for general industrial applications. Order Table: Features: 3A steady state 10 times steady state current Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6 .35 mm) male quick connect terminals Encapsulated -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C ≅ 2.2 oz (62 g) Features: •Fixed at 90 FPM •Custom flash rate 10 - 180 FPM •3A, SPST output contact •12 to 110VDC input voltages in 5 ranges •Totally solid state & encapsulated •0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: FS224 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 times steady state current Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Encapsulated -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C ≅ 2.2 oz (62 g) 105 Flashers FS300 / FS400 Series The FS300 Series of solid-state flashers were specifically designed to operate lamp loads. Their two-terminal series connection feature makes installation easy. The high immunity to line noise and transients makes the FS300 Series ideal for moving vehicle applications. All solid-state construction means reliability and long life. The FS300 Series offers a factory fixed flash rate of 75 FPM or may be ordered with a fixed, custom flash rate ranging from 60 to 150 FPM. Operation Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2. Order Table: Input 12VDC ±20% 24VDC ±20% 36VDC ±20% 48VDC ±15% 72VDC ±15% 110VDC ±15% Maximum Current Load 2.5A 1.5A 1A 0.75A 0.5A 0.25A Part Number FS312 FS324 FS336 FS348 FS372 FS390 For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (OFF First) function. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 5 for connection diagram. Features: •All solid state – no moving parts or contacts •High surge capability – designed to operate incandescent lamp loads •High noise & transient protection •Two-terminal series connection •Encapsulated – protects against shock, vibration, & humidity Auxiliary Products: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: FS312 FS324 FS336 FS390 Specifications Technical Data Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Custom Flash Rates. . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OFF/ON recycling solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Fixed at 75 FPM ±10% 60 - 150 FPM ≅ 50% 12, 24, 36, 48, 72, & 110VDC Incandescent or resistive 0.25 - 2.5A steady state 10 times steady state current Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The FS400 Series is a low leakage AC flasher designed to control LED, or resistive loads. This series offers a solid-state output and may be ordered with an input voltage of 24V to 240VAC, in two ranges. It offers a factory fixed flash rate of 75 FPM or may be ordered with a fixed, custom flash rate ranging from 45 to 150 FPM. The FS400 is the perfect solution for LED lamp flashing. Operation Upon application of input voltage, the output energizes and the ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the flash sequence. Order Table: Input Voltage 120 to 240VAC 24VAC Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Encapsulated -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.2 oz (62 g) Features: •Low leakage for LED lamps •Fixed flash rate at 75 FPM •Custom flash rate 45 - 150 FPM •0.5 or 1A, solid-state output •24V to 240VAC in 2 ranges •Small size: 1.5 x 0.94 in. (38 x 23.9 mm) Approvals: Available Models: FS491 For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (ON First) function. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 12 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 6 for connection diagram. Output Rating 0.5A 1A Part Number FS491 FS421 Specifications Technical Data Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .ON/OFF solid-state flasher (continuous duty) Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed at 75 FPM ±20% Custom Flash Rates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 - 150 FPM ±20% ON/OFF Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 50% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, or 120 - 240VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ± 15% AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED or resistive Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bridge Rectifier & FET Maximum Load Rating 120VAC to 240VAC. . . . . . . . 0.5A steady state; 5A inrush 24VAC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state; 10A inrush 106 Max. Load Leakage Current. . . . . . . . . . . . 250µA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2V typical Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #8 (M4 x 0.7) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 x 0.94 in. (38.1 x 23.9 mm) Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41 - 1991 Level A Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 1.1 oz (31 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Flashers FS500 / AF Series The FS500 Series flash rate is adjustable from 10 to 100 FPM. A locknut is provided to hold selected flash rate. The long-life electronic circuit combined with a quality electromechanical relay provides flexibility and reliability in most applications. Operation Upon application of input voltage, the output relay is energized and the ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output relay de-energizes and the OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output is energized and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence. Order Table: Input Voltage 12VDC 24VAC/DC 120VAC/DC 230VAC Part Number FS512 FS524 FS590 FS599 For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (ON First-DPDT) function. Appendix B, page 165, Figure 9 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 8 for connection diagram. Features: •Solid-state circuitry - relay output •Industrial standard octal plug-in •Adjustable flash rate 10 - 100 FPM •10A, DPDT output contacts Approvals: (some models) Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: FS512 FS524 FS590 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Specifications Technical Data Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF recycling flasher with adjustable flash rate Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 10 - 100 operations per minute (guaranteed range) ON/OFF Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 50% Input Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12VDC, 24VAC/DC, 120VAC/DC, 230VAC Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . . -15% - 20% 120 - 230VAC/DC . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Order Table: AF X Input Voltage ─1 ─ - 24VAC ─2 ─ - 120VAC ─3 ─ - 230VAC X Output Rating ─1 ─ - 6A ─2 ─ - 10A ─3 ─ - 20A Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/ 240VAC Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.62 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (91.6 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . > 1500V RMS input to output Polarity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .DC units are reverse polarity protected Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -30° to 85°C Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5.8 oz (164 g) The AF Series offers a high inrush capacity of up to 200A. These devices exceed mechanical type relays in both performance and lifespan. The AF Series is constructed with no moving parts to arc, wear, and eventually fail; 100 million operations are typical. Circuitry is encapsulated to provide protection against vibration and moisture, making the AF Series ideal for outdoor applications. Features: Operation Upon application of input voltage T1 begins, Load 1 is ON and Load 2 is OFF. At the end of T1, T2 begins and Load 2 is now ON and Load 1 is OFF. At the end of T2, T1 repeats and this sequence continues until input voltage is removed. The duration of T1 and T2 is approximately equal. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the flasher. Auxiliary Products: For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (Alternating) function. Appendix B, page 166, Figure 13 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 7 for connection diagram. X Flash Rate (flashes per min.) ─1 ─ - 10 ─2 ─ - 30 ─3 ─ - 60 ─4 ─ - 90 ─5 ─ - 120 ─6 ─ - 140 ─Blank ─ - Custom Flash Rate •Alternately flashes two high current loads •High surge capacity - up to 200A •Small size - 2 x 2 x 1.30 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 33 mm) •Totally solid state & encapsulated • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Available Models: AF213 AF223 AF232 AF233 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Specifications Technical Data Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Alternating solid-state flasher rated (continuous duty) Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed at 10, 30, 60, 90, 120, or 140 flashes per min. ±10%. Custom Flash Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 140 FPM Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 50% Input Input Voltage/Frequency . . . . . . . . .24, 120, or 230VAC ±15% / 50/60Hz Output Load Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Incandescent or resistive Maximum Load Rating. . . . . . . . . . . 6, 10, & 20A steady state www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Inrush. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting * . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 times steady state current Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.30 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 33 mm) Encapsulated -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.9 oz (82 g) *Must be bolted to metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. 107 Flasher (Chaser) SC3/SC4 Series The SC3/SC4 Series are solid-state 3 or 4 channel, chasers designed for sequential three or four circuit flashing of incandescent lamp loads. Unlike electromechanical chasers, there are no contacts to arc, wear, and eventually fail. Fixed or adjustable rates of 30 to 300 operations per minute. Operation Sequential 3 or 4 circuit flashing of incandescent loads with equal time delays for each load. Upon application of input voltage, Load 1 is energized. At the end of the time delay, Load 1 de-energizes and Load 2 energizes. At the end of the time delay, Load 2 de-energizes and Load 3 energizes. This cycle continues until input voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the unit and cycle. For more information see: Appendix A, page 164 for Flasher (Chasing) function. Appendix B, page 166, Figure 14 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 9 for connection diagram. Features: •Sequential 3 or 4 circuit flashing of incandescent loads •Fixed or adjustable at 30 - 300FPM •1A steady state output •24, 120, or 230VAC input voltage •Totally solid state - encapsulated Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: SC3120F30 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: SC3 (3 outputs) SC4 (4 outputs) X Input Voltage ─24 ─ - 24VAC ─120 ─ - 120VAC ─230 ─ - 230VAC X Rate ─A ─ - Adjustable (30 - 300) ─F ─ - Fixed* *If Fixed is selected, insert (30 - 300) operations per minute. Specifications Technical Data Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sequential 3 or 4 circuit flashing of incandescent lamp loads. Fixed or adjustable rates. Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable: 30 - 300 operations per minute Fixed: 30 - 300 operations per minute (±10%) Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC ±15% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady state per output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.22 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 31 mm) 108 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 5.4 oz (153 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 3-Phase Voltage Monitors WVM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DLMU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HLMU. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLMU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PLM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TVW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TVM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 Low Volts, Phase Reversal PLR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Phase Reversal PLS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 1-Phase Voltage Monitors HLV. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 KVM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors & Phase Monitors Series Included 109 Voltage Monitors WVM Series The WVM Series provides protection against premature equipment (motor) failure caused by voltage faults on the 3-phase line. The WVM’s microcontroller design provides reliable protection even if regenerated voltages are present. It combines dependable fault sensing with a 10 fault memory and a 6 LED status display. Part instrument, part control, the WVM protects your equipment when you’re not there and displays what happened when you return. The WVM is fully adjustable and includes time delays to prevent nuisance tripping and improve system operation. Time delays include a 0.25 to 30s adjustable trip delay, an adjustable 0.25 to 64m (in 3 ranges) restart delay, plus a unique 3 to 15s true random start delay. The random start delay prevents voltage sags caused by simultaneous restarting of numerous motor loads after a power outage. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 15 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page, 168, Figure 10 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase loss & reversal; over, under & unbalanced voltages; & short cycling •10 fault memory & status displayed on 6 LED readout •Switch selectable automatic restart, delayed automatic restart, & manual reset •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •ASME A17.1 Rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: Operation WVM011AL WVM911AL The output relay is energized when all conditions are acceptable and the WVM is reset. A restart and/or random start WVM611AH WVM911AL-60 delay may occur before the output relay is energized. WVM611AL WVM911RL Field Adjustment: Select the line voltage listed on the motor’s name plate. This automatically sets the over and undervoltage WVM811AH WVM911RN-60 trip points. No further adjustment should be required to achieve maximum equipment protection. WVM911AH Read Memory: Fault(s) stored in the memory are indicated when the yellow LED is flashing, up to 10 faults are noted. If desired part number is not listed, please call us Memory Reset: To clear the memory of all faults stored, rotate selector to Clear Memory for 5 seconds. The yellow LED will turn off. to see if it is technically possible to build. Memory Overload: Only the 10 most recent faults are retained. Random Start Delay: A new 3 to 15s random start delay is selected by the microcontroller when a fault is corrected and when the operating voltage (L1, L2, L3) is applied to the WVM. A random start delay does not occur when the reset is manual. Automatic Restart: Upon fault correction, the output will re-energize after a random start delay. Automatic Restart Upon Fault Trip: When a fault is sensed for the full trip delay, the output de- energizes and a restart delay is initiated. This delay locks out the output for the delay period. Should the fault be corrected by the end of the restart delay, the output will re-energize after a random start delay. A restart delay will also occur when operating voltage (L1, L2, L3) is applied to the WVM. Manual Reset: After a fault condition is corrected, the WVM can be manually reset. There are two methods; a customer supplied remote switch, or the onboard selector switch. Manual Reset (Onboard): Rotate selector switch from the Manual Reset position to Auto Restart w/ Delay then back again to Manual Reset within 3 seconds. The output will immediately energize. Remote Reset: Reset (Restart) is accomplished by a momentary contact closure across terminals 1 & 2. The output will immediately energize. Remote switch requirements are ≥10mA @ 20VDC and the reset terminals are not isolated from line voltage. A resistance of ≤20KΩ across terminals 1 & 2 will cause immediate automatic restart. Automatic Restart Upon Fault Correction: (P/N includes an R) When a fault is sensed for the full trip delay, the output relay de-energizes. Upon correction of the fault, a restart delay begins. At the end of this delay, the output will re-energize after a random start delay. If a fault occurs during restart timing, the restart time delay will be reset to zero, and the output will not energize until the restart delay is completed. Order Table: WVM X 3-Phase Line Voltage ─6 ─ - 200-240VAC ─8 ─ - 355-425VAC ─9 ─ - 400-480VAC ─0 ─ - 500-600VAC X Unbalance ─1 ─ - 2-10% X Trip Delay ─1 ─ - 0.25-30s X Reset Method ─A ─ - Switch Selectable: Automatic restart upon fault trip ─R ─ - Swith Selectable: Automatic restart upon fault correction X Restart Delay ─L ─ - 0.25-64s ─N ─ - 6-300s ─H ─ - 0.25-64m -60 Option: Add the suffix -60 to any automatic restart part number to remove the random start delay feature. Specifications Fault Memory Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Nonvolatile RAM Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stores last 10 faults Operating Voltage Model Adj. Line Voltage Range Status Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 LEDs provide existing status & memory readout 240 200-240VAC Note: 50% of operating line voltage must be applied to L1 & L2 for operation of status indicators 380 355-425VAC Output 480 400-480VAC Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay 600 500-600VAC Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 250VAC; 6A inductive (0.4 PF) @ 250VAC Overvoltage, Undervoltage, & Voltage Unbalance Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107 Overvoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109-113% of adjusted voltage Protection Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . -2% of trip point Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE 62.41-1991 Level B Undervoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-92% of adjusted voltage Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +2% of trip point Voltage Unbalance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 2-10%*Mechanical Trip Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 0.25 - 30s ±15% Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface with 2 or 4 #8 (M4 x 0.7) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.9 x 4.4 x 2.4 in. (175.3 x 111.8 x 61.0 mm) Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 15% unbalance Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screw terminals with captive wire clamps for up to Response Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 200 ms #12 AWG ( 3.2 mm2) wire Random Start Delay Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 15s Environmental Reset (Restart) Delay Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -40° to 65°C / -40° to 85°C Low Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25-64s ±15% Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅25 oz ( 709 g) Normal Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-300s ±15% High Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25-64m ±15% * Unbalance reset is 90% of the unbalance setting (i.e. VUB at 5% reset is 4.5%) 110 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors DLMU Series The DLMU Series is a universal voltage, 3-phase voltage monitor. It continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases with microcontroller accuracy and compares the value to preset trip points. It separately senses phase reversal and loss; over, under and unbalanced voltages; and over or under frequency. Protection is assured during periods of large average voltage fluctuations or when regenerated voltages are present. The unit trips within 200ms when phase loss is detected. Adjustable time delays are included to prevent nuisance tripping and short cycling of sensitive equipment. The isolated, 10A, SPDT and 2A alarm output relay contacts trip when a phase voltage exceeds the trip limits for the trip delay. Nominal line voltage, voltage unbalance, and time delays are knob adjustable. The phase loss setpoint and the acceptable frequency range are fixed. Both delta and wye systems can be monitored; no connection to neutral is required. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 16 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 11 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase & reversal; over, under & unbalanced voltages; & over & under frequency •35mm DIN rail or surface mounting •Isolated, 10A, relay contacts •Isolated, 2A, NO or NC, SPST relay contact •LED indicates relay, faults, & time delays •Universal line voltage 240 to 480VAC •600VAC version available •3-wire connection for delta or wye systems •ASME A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Operation Upon application of line voltage, the output is de-energized and the restart delay begins. If all the 3-phase voltages are within the acceptable range, the output energizes at the end of the restart delay. The microcontroller circuitry automatically Available Models: senses the voltage range, and selects the correct operating frequency (50 or 60Hz). The over and undervoltage trip points DLMHBRAAA are set automatically. When the measured value of any phase voltage exceeds the acceptable range limits (lower or upper) DLMUBNAAN the trip delay begins. At the end of the trip delay the output relay de-energizes. If the phase voltage returns to an acceptable DLMUBRAAA value before the trip delay expires, the trip delay is reset and the output remains energized. Under, over, and unbalanced voltages plus over or under frequency must be sensed for the complete trip delay before the unit trips. The unit trips in If desired part number is not listed, please call us 200ms when phase loss or reversal are sensed. The unit will not energize if a fault is sensed as the line voltage is applied. to see if it is technically possible to build. Reset: Reset is automatic upon correction of the voltage or frequency fault or phase sequence. Restart Delay Options: L= Lockout or minimum OFF time. The restart delay begins when the output trips. The unit cannot be re-energized until the restart delay is complete. This provides a minimum off time or lockout time to allow equipment sensitive to short cycling, time to reset. If the fault is corrected after the restart delay is complete the output energizes immediately. The restart delay also occurs when line voltage is applied/reapplied. R= Restart Delay on fault correction. The restart delay begins when line voltage is reapplied or when a voltage fault is corrected. This option is normally selected when staggered restarting of multiple motors on a power system is required. N= No Restart Delay. 0.6 second initialization delay on application of line voltage applies. Restart Notes: All restart options remain reset when the following conditions are detected: 1.) Phase loss (phase unbalance greater than 25%) 2.) Average line voltage less than 120VAC 3.) Phase reversal The restart delay begins when the condition is corrected. LED Operation The LED flashes green during the restart delay, then glows green when the output energizes. It flashes red during the trip delay then glows red when the output de-energizes. It flashes red/green if phase reversal is sensed If a fault is sensed during the restart delay, the LED will glow red during that portion or the full restart delay. Order Table: DLM X Line Voltage ─U ─ - 200-480VAC ─H ─ - 500-600VAC X Output ─B ─ - SPDT & NO ─C ─ - SPDT & NC X Restart Function ─L ─ - Lockout, min off time ─R ─ - Staggered restarting ─N ─ - No Restart Delay X Voltage Unbalance ─A ─ - Adjustable 2-10% ─Fixed ─ - Specify unbalance 2-10% in 1% increments using two digits [04] X Trip Delay ─A ─ - Adjustable 1-30s ─Fixed ─ - Specify delay 1-30s in 1s increments, using two digits [20] X Restart Delay ─A* ─ - Adjustable 0.6-300s ─N ─ - No Restart Delay * Selection “A” is only available for L or R Restart Functions Specifications Line Voltage Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Operating Voltage 200-480VAC Range Voltage Adj.Range Line Frequency Line Voltage Max. 240 200-240VAC 50/60Hz 380 340-420VAC 50Hz 480 400-480VAC 60Hz 550VAC 600VAC 600 500-600VAC 50/60Hz 600VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz automatically detected Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 25% unbalance Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .≤200ms Undervoltage & Voltage Unbalance Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delayed trip & automatic reset Overvoltage TripVoltage. . . . . . 109 - 113% of the adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage . . . . ≅ -3% of the trip voltage Undervoltage Trip Voltage . . . . . 88 - 92% of the adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage. . . . ≅ +3% of the trip voltage Voltage Unbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable 2 - 10% or specify fixed unbalance of 2 - 10% in 1% increments Reset on balance. . . ≅ -0.7% unbalance Trip Delay Active On. . . . . . . . . . Over/undervoltage, voltage unbalance, over/under frequency Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 1 - 30s or specify fixed delay 1 - 30s in 1s increments Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . ± 15% www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Restart Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 0.6 - 300s; if no restart delay is selected a 0.6s initialization delay applies Tolerance. . . . . . . . . ± 15% Over/Under Frequency. . . . . . . . . . ±4%; Reset ±3%; 50/60 Hz Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A, B, C, L1, L2, L3 Response Time -Phase Reversal & Phase Loss. . . . ≤200 ms Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Output Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated Electromechanical Relay Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 8A resistive @ 277VAC; NO-1/4 hp @ 120VAC; 1/3 hp @ 240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 303 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with 2 #8 (M4 x 0.7) screw or snapon 35mm DIN Rail Note: 0.25 in.(6.35 mm) spacing between units or other devices is required Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.33 x 2.95 x 1.97 in. (110 x 75 x 50 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screw terminals with captive wire clamps for up to #14 AWG (2.5 mm2) wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 8.6 oz (244 g) 111 Voltage Monitors HLMU Series The HLMU Series is a universal voltage, encapsulated, 3-phase voltage monitor. It continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases with microcontroller accuracy and compares the value to preset trip points. It separately senses phase reversal and loss; over, under and unbalanced voltages; and over or under frequency. Protection is assured during periods of large average voltage fluctuations, or when regenerated voltages are present. The unit trips within 200ms when phase loss is detected. Adjustable time delays are included to prevent nuisance tripping and short cycling of sensitive equipment. The isolated, 10A, DPDT relay contacts trip when a phase voltage exceeds the trip limits for the trip delay. Nominal line voltage, voltage unbalance, and time delays are knob adjustable. The phase loss setpoint and the acceptable frequency range are fixed. Both delta and wye systems can be monitored; no connection to neutral is required. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 17 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 12 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase loss & reversal; over, under & unbalanced voltages; & over & under frequency •Encapsulated circuitry •Isolated, 10A, DPDT output contacts •LED indicates relay status, faults, & time delays •Universal line voltage 200 to 480VAC in one unit •Compact design •Finger-safe terminal blocks, up to 12 AWG •ASME A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • 3-Phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Operation Upon application of line voltage, the output is de-energized and the restart delay begins. If all the three-phase voltages are within the acceptable range, the output energizes at the end of the restart delay. The microcontroller circuitry automatically senses the voltage range, and selects the correct operating frequency (50 or 60Hz). The over and under voltage trip points are set at ± 10% of the adjusted line voltage. When the measured value of any phase voltage exceeds the acceptable range Available Models: limits (lower or upper) the trip delay begins. At the end of the trip delay the output relay de-energizes. If the phase voltage HLMUDLAAA HLMUDRAAA returns to an acceptable value before the trip delay expires, the trip delay is reset and the output remains energized. Under, HLMUDN0405N HLMUSR0604A over, and unbalanced voltages plus over or under frequency must be sensed for the complete trip delay before the unit HLMUDNAAN trips. The unit trips in 200ms when phase loss or reversal are sensed. The unit will not energize if a fault is sensed as the line voltage is applied. If desired part number is not listed, please call Reset: Reset is automatic upon correction of the voltage or frequency fault or phase sequence. us to see if it is technically possible to build. Restart Delay Options: L= Lockout or minimum OFF time. The restart delay begins when the output trips. The unit cannot be re-energized until the restart delay is complete. This provides a minimum off time or lockout time to allow equipment sensitive to short cycling, time to reset. If the fault is corrected after the restart delay is complete, the output energizes immediately. The restart delay also occurs when line voltage is applied/reapplied. R= Restart Delay on fault correction. The restart delay begins when line voltage is reapplied or when a voltage fault is corrected. This option is normally selected when staggered restarting of multiple motors on a power system is required. N= No Restart Delay. 0.6 second initialization delay on application of line voltage applies. Restart Notes: All restart options remain reset when the following conditions are detected: 1.) Phase loss (phase unbalance greater than 25%) 2.) Average line voltage less than 120VAC 3.) Phase reversal The restart delay begins when the condition is corrected. LED Operation The LED flashes green during the restart delay, then glows green when the output energizes. It flashes red during the trip delay then glows red when the output de-energizes. It flashes red/green if phase reversal is sensed. If a fault is sensed during the restart delay, the LED will glow red during that portion or the full restart delay. Order Table: HLMU X Output ─D ─ - DPDT ─S ─ - SPDT X Restart Function ─L ─ - Lockout, Min Off Time ─R ─ - Staggered Restarting ─N ─ - No Restart Delay X Voltage Unbalance ─A ─ - Adjustable 2-10% ─Fixed ─ - Specify Unbalance 2-10% in 1% increments, using two digits [04] X Trip Delay ─A ─ - Adjustable 1-30s ─Fixed ─ - Specify delay 1-30s in 1s increments, using two digits [05] X Restart Delay ─A* ─ - Adjustable 0.6-300s ─N ─ - No Restart Delay *Selection “A” is only available for Restart Functions “L” and “R” Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Operating Voltage 200 - 480VAC Range Voltage Adj. Range Frequency 240 200-240VAC 50 or 60Hz 380 340-420VAC 50Hz 480 400-480VAC 60Hz Line Voltage Max. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz automatically detected Phase Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 25% unbalance Response Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤200ms Undervoltage & Voltage Unbalance Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delayed trip & automatic reset Overvoltage Trip Voltage. . . . . . 109 - 113% of the adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage . . . . ≅ -3% of the trip voltage Undervoltage Trip Voltage. . . . . . 88 - 92% of the adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage . . . . ≅ +3% of the trip voltage Voltage Unbalance Trip Setpoint . . . . . Adjustable 2 - 10% or specify fixed unbalance of 2 - 10% in 1% increments Reset on Balance. ≅ -0.7% unbalance Trip Delay Active On. . . . . . . . Over/undervoltage, voltage unbalance, over/under frequency Range. . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 1 - 30s or specify fixed delay 1 - 30s in 1s increments Tolerance. . . . . . . . ± 15% Restart Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 0.6 - 300s; if no restart delay is selected a 0.6s initialization delay applies Tolerance. . . . . . . . ± 15% 112 Over/Under Frequency.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±4%; Reset ±3%; 50/60 Hz Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A, B, C, L1, L2, L3 Response Time-Phase Reversal & Phase Loss. . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤200 ms Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated Electromechanical Relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 8A resistive @ 277VAC; NO-1/4 hp @ 120VAC; 1/3 hp @ 240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106 Electrical (at 10A) - DPDT - 1 x 303 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.7) screw Note: 0.25 in.(6.35 mm) spacing between units or other devices is required Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.64 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 41.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screw terminal connection up to 12 AWG (3.3 mm2) wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors PLMU Series The PLMU Series continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases to provide protection for 3-phase motors and sensitive loads. Its microcontroller senses under and overvoltage, voltage unbalance, phase loss, and phase reversal. Protection is provided even when regenerated voltages are present. Universal voltage operation and standard base connection allows the PLMU to replace hundreds of competitive part numbers. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 18 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 13 for connection diagram. Operation Upon application of power, a 0.6s random start delay begins and the PLMU measures the voltage levels and line frequency and selects the voltage range. The output relay is energized and the LED glows green when all voltages are acceptable and the phase sequence is correct. LED flashes green during trip delay, glows red when output de-energizes. Undervoltage, overvoltage, and voltage unbalance must be sensed for continuous trip delay before the relay de-energizes. Re-energization is automatic upon fault correction. The output relay will not energize if a fault condition is sensed as 3-phase input voltage is applied. The LED alternately flashes red/green when phase reversal is sensed. Line voltage is selected with the knob, setting the over and under voltage trip points. Voltage range is automatically selected by the microcontroller. Features: •Protects against phase & reversal; & over, under & unbalanced voltages •Octal plug-in •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Operates from 200 to 480VAC •LED indicator glows green when voltages are acceptable, red for faults •Indicates reverse-phase wiring •Simple 3-wire connection for delta or wye systems •ASME A17.1 Rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxilary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 8-pin octal socket: P/N: OT08PC • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PLMU11 LED Indicator Order Table: Voltage Unbalance Adjustable 2-10% Trip Delay Adjustable 0.25-30s Part Number PLMU11 Steady Green Energized Steady Red De-engergized (tripped on fault) Flashing Green Trip Delay Alternate Flashing Red/Green Phase Reversal Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Line Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 to 480VAC ±15%, 50/60 Hz ±2 Hz Adjustable Voltage Ranges (Automatic Range Selection). . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 to 240VAC, 50/60 Hz 340 to 420VAC, 50 Hz 400 to 480VAC, 60 Hz Maximum Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552VAC Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABC Overvoltage, Undervoltage, & Voltage Unbalance Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delayed trip & automatic reset Overvoltage & Undervoltage Undervoltage Trip Point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 - 92% of adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +2% of trip voltage Overvoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 - 113% of adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . -2% of trip voltage Voltage Unbalance Trip Point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 2 - 10% Factory fixed from 4 - 10% (a minimum order quantity applies) Reset on Balance (%): Selected Unbalance 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Reset 1.5 2.5 3.5 4.5 5.4 6.3 7.2 8.1 9 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Trip Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable from 0.25 - 30s Factory fixed from 2 - 30s ±15% (a minimum order quantity applies) Severe Unbalance - 2X Selected Unbalance . . 0.25 - 2s; disabled when the trip delay is less than 2s Random Start Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 0.6s Phase Reversal & Phase Loss Trip Time. . . . . . ≤ 150ms Phase Loss Setpoint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 15% unbalance Reset Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Energized when voltages are acceptable Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/3 hp @ 250VAC; max. 277VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106 ; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket rated 600VAC Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.03 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (77.0 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 8.6 oz (244 g) *CAUTION: Select an octal socket rated for 600VAC operation. 113 Voltage Monitors PLM Series The PLM Series continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases. The PLM Series uses a microcontroller circuit design that senses undervoltage, voltage unbalance, phase loss, and phase reversal. Protection is assured when regenerated voltages are present. Both delta and wye systems can be monitored; no connection to neutral is required. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 13 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase loss & reversal; & under & unbalanced voltages •8-pin plug-in base •Adjustable low voltage trip point •Factory fixed unbalance & trip delay •Line voltages 200 to 480VAC in 3 ranges •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •ASME A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Operation The output relay is energized and the LED glows green when all voltages are acceptable and the phase sequence is correct. Under and unbalanced voltages must be sensed for a continuous trip delay period before the relay de-energizes. Reset is automatic upon correction of the fault condition. The output relay will not energize if a fault condition is sensed as power is applied. The LED flashes red during the trip delay, then glows red when the output de-energizes. The LED flashes green/red if phase reversal is sensed. Field Adjustment: Set voltage adjustment knob at the desired operating line voltage for the equipment. This adjustment automatically sets the undervoltage trip point. Apply power. If the PLM fails to energize, (LED glows red) check wiring of all 3 phases, voltage, and phase sequence. If phase sequence is incorrect, the LED flashes green/red. To correct this, swap any two line voltage connections at the mounting socket. No further adjustment should be required. • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: OT08PC • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PLM6405 PLM6502 PLM6805 PLM8405 PLM8805 PLM9405 PLM9502 PLM9805 PLM9820 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: PLM X Line Voltage ─6 ─ - 240VAC ─8 ─ - 380VAC ─9 ─ - 480VAC X Voltage Unbalanced ─Fixed ─ - Specify - 4-8% in 1% increments X Trip Delay ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 2-20s in 1s increments using two digits Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Operating Voltage: Model Adj. Line Voltage Range Line Voltage Max. 240 200-240VAC 270VAC 380 360-430VAC 480VAC 480 400-480VAC 530VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/100 Hz Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABC Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2W for 240V units ≅ 3W for 380 - 480V units Low Voltage & Voltage Unbalance Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delayed trip & automatic reset Low Voltage Trip Voltage. . . . . . . 88 - 92% of adjusted line voltage Reset Voltage.. . . . . Plus 3% of trip voltage Voltage Unbalance Trip Unbalance. . . . . Factory fixed from 4 - 8% Reset on Balance . . -0.7% unbalance typical Trip Delay Range . . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed from 2 - 20s Tolerance . . . . . . . . . ±15% Phase Reversal & Phase Loss Response Time: Phase Reversal . . . . . . . ≤ 200ms Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 200ms 114 Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . > 35% unbalance Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC, 277VAC max; 1/2 Hp @ 240VAC; 1/4 Hp @ 120VAC 5 7 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; Electrical - 1 x 10 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Mechanical Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-pin plug-in socket rated 600VAC Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 4.4 oz (125 g) *CAUTION: Select an octal socket rated for 600VAC operation. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors TVW Series Provides protection for motors and other sensitive loads. Continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases using a microcontroller circuit design that senses under and overvoltage, voltage unbalance, phase loss, and phase reversal. Protection is provided even when regenerated voltages are present. Includes a trip delay to prevent nuisance tripping and a restart delay to prevent short cycling after a momentary power outage. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 30 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 14 for connection diagram. Operation Upon application of line voltage, the restart delay begins. The output is de-energized during restart delay. Under normal conditions, the output energizes after the restart delay. Undervoltage, overvoltage, and voltage unbalance must be sensed for the complete trip delay period before the output de-energizes. The restart delay begins as soon as the output de-energizes. If the restart delay is completed when a fault is corrected, the output energizes immediately. The output will not energize if a fault is sensed as the input voltage is applied. If the voltage selector is set between two voltage marks (i.e. between 220 and 230V), the LED will flash red rapidly. The TVW provides fault protection at the lower of the two line voltages (i.e. 220V). Reset: Reset is automatic upon correction of a fault. LED Operation The LED flashes green during the restart delay, then glows green when the output energizes. It flashes red during the trip delay then glows red when the output de-energizes. It flashes red/green if phase reversal is sensed. If the voltage selector knob is between settings, it rapidly flashes red. Features: •Protects against phase loss & reversal; over, under & unbalanced voltages; short cycling •Fixed trip points & delays •Adjustable voltages from 208 to 480VAC in 4 ranges •Monitor 600VAC lines by connecting VRM accessory •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •Bi-color LED indicates: output status, faults, time delays, phase reversal & setpoint •ASME A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxilary Products: • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Voltage reduction module: P/N: VRM6048 Available Models: TVW575S1M TVW6510S0.4S TVW9510S0.4S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TVW X Line Voltage Wide Range ─5 ─ - 208-240VAC Selectable ─6 ─ - 208, 220, 230 & 240VAC ─8 ─ - 380, 400 & 415VAC ─9 ─ - 430, 440, 460 & 480VAC X Voltage Unbalance ─Fixed ─ - Specify 4-10% in 1% increments X Trip Delay* ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 0.2-1s in 0.1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-100s in 1s increments *Must indicate (S) for secs. or (M) for mins. X Restart Delay* ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 0.4-1s in 0.1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-100s in 1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-999min in 1min increments Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage/Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral 208 to 480VAC in 4 ranges/-30% - 20% 50 - 100 Hz ABC Approx. 2W for 240V units Approx. 3W for 480V units Overvoltage, Undervoltage, & Voltage Unbalance Overvoltage & Undervoltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delay trip & automatic reset Undervoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 - 92% of the selected line voltage Reset Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ +3% of trip voltage Overvoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 - 113% of the selected line voltage Reset Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ -3% of trip voltage Trip Variation vs Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Voltage Unbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed, from 4 - 10% Reset On Balance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ -0.7% unbalance Trip Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed from 0.2 - 100s ±15% or ±0.1s, whichever is greater Restart Delay Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed from 0.4s - 999m ±15% or ±0.2s, whichever is greater www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Phase Reversal & Phase Loss Response. . . . ≤ 200ms; automatic reset Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 25% unbalance Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating 208 to 240VAC (55°C) . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC, 5A @ 250VAC, 1/4 hp @ 125VAC 380 to 480VAC . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC, 1/4 hp @ 125VAC, 1/3 hp @ 250VAC, max. voltage 277VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Dielectric Breakdown 208 to 240VAC. . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output terminals 380 to 480VAC . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output terminals Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #8 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.25 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 31.8 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 55°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.8 oz (79 g) 115 Voltage Monitors TVM Series Provides protection for motors and other sensitive loads. Continuously measures the voltage of each of the three phases using a microcomputer circuit design that senses under and overvoltage, voltage unbalance, phase loss, and phase reversal. Protection is provided even when regenerated voltages are present. Includes a trip delay to prevent nuisance tripping and a restart delay to prevent short cycling after a momentary power outage. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 30 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 14 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase loss & reversal; over, under & unbalanced voltages; short cycling •Fixed trip points & delays •Fixed voltages from 208 to 480VAC •Isolated, 10A, SPDT ouput contacts •Bi-color LED indicator shows: output status, faults, time delays & phase reversal •ASME A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Operation Upon application of line voltage, the restart delay begins. The output relay is de-energized during restart delay. Under normal conditions, the output energizes after restart delay. Undervoltage, overvoltage, and voltage unbalance must be sensed for continuous trip delay period before the output is de-energized. The output will not de-energize if a fault is corrected during the trip delay. The restart delay begins as soon as the output relay deenergizes. If the restart delay is completed when the fault is corrected, the output relay will energize immediately. The output relay will not energize if a fault or phase reversal is sensed as 3-phase input voltage is applied. Reset: Reset is automatic upon correction of a fault. LED Operation The LED flashes green during the restart delay, then glows green when the output energizes. It flashes red during the trip delay then glows red when the output de-energizes. It flashes red/green if phase reversal is sensed. • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • Voltage reduction module: P/N: VRM6048 Available Models: TVM208A100.5S3S TVM460A510S5S TVM230A101S1S TVM460A75S2M TVM400A101S1S TVM480A100.5S3S TVM460A101S1S TVM480A50.5S2S TVM460A41S5M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: TVM X Line Voltage ─208A ─ - 208VAC ─220A ─ - 220VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC ─240A ─ - 240VAC ─380A ─ - 380VAC ─400A ─ - 400VAC ─415A ─ - 415VAC ─440A ─ - 440VAC ─460A ─ - 460VAC ─480A ─ - 480VAC X Voltage Unbalance ─Fixed ─ - Specify 4-10% in 1% increments X Trip Delay* ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 0.2-1s in 0.1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-100s in 1s increments X Restart Delay* ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 0.5-1s in 0.1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-100s in 1s increments ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-999 min in 1min increments *Must indicate (S) for secs. or (M) for mins. Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral 208 to 480VAC 50 - 100 Hz ABC Approx. 2W for 240V units Approx. 3W for 480V units Overvoltage, Undervoltage, & Voltage Unbalance Overvoltage & Undervoltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage detection with delay trip & automatic reset Undervoltage Trip Point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 - 92% of the selected line voltage Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ +3% of trip voltage Overvoltage Trip Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 - 113% of the selected line voltage Reset Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ -3% of trip voltage Trip Variation vs Temperature . . . . . . . . . . ≤ ±2% Voltage Unbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed from 4 - 10% Reset On Balance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ -0.7% unbalance Trip Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed from 0.2 - 100s ±15% or ±0.1s, whichever is greater Restart Delay Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed from 0.5s - 999m ±15% or ±0.2s, whichever is greater Phase Reversal & Phase Loss Response. . . . ≤ 200ms; automatic reset Phase Loss. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 25% unbalance 116 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT relay contacts Rating 208 to 240VAC (55°C) . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 125VAC, 5A @ 250VAC, 1/4 hp @ 125VAC 380 to 480VAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC, 1/4 hp @ 125VAC, 1/3 hp @ 250VAC, max. voltage 277VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Dielectric Breakdown 208 to 240VAC. . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output terminals 380 to 480VAC. . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output terminals Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #8 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.25 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 31.8 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -40° to 55°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.8 oz (79 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors PLR Series The PLR Series provides a cost effective means of preventing 3-phase motor startup during adverse voltage conditions. Proper A-B-C sequence must occur in order for the PLR’s output contacts to energize. In addition, the relay will not energize when an undervoltage or phase loss condition is present. The PLR protects a motor against undervoltage operation. The adjustment knob sets the undervoltage trip point. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 8 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 13 for connection diagram. Features: •Protects against phase loss (on startup), phase reversal & undervoltage •Used where moderate voltage unbalance protection is not required •Direct replacement for most popular 3-phase monitors •8-pin octal base connection •Isolated, 5A, SPDT output contacts •AMSE A17.1 rule 210.6 •NEMA MG1 14:30, 14:35 •IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Approvals: Auxilary Products: Operation The output relay is energized and the LED glows when all voltages are acceptable and the phase sequence is correct. Undervoltage must be sensed for a continuous dropout delay period before the relay de-energizes. Reset is automatic upon correction of the fault condition. The output relay will not energize if a fault condition is sensed as power is applied. Field Adjustment: Turn the adjustment knob fully counterclockwise and apply three-phase power. The LED should be ON. Increase adjustment until the LED goes OFF. Decrease adjustment until LED glows again. If nuisance tripping occurs, decrease the adjustment slightly. NOTE: When properly adjusted and operating in an average system, a voltage unbalance of 10% or more is required for phase loss detection. When a phase is lost while the motor is running, a voltage will be induced into the open phase nearly equal in magnitude to the normal phase-to-phase voltage. This condition is known as regeneration. When regenerated voltages are present, the voltage unbalance during single phasing may not exceed 10% for some motors. The PLR Series may not provide protection under this condition. For systems that require superior phase loss protection, select the PLMU Series. • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: OT08PC • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PLR120A PLR240A PLR380A PLR480A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: Voltage 95-140VAC 190-270VAC 340-450VAC 380-500VAC Part Number PLR120A PLR240A PLR380A PLR480A Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Nominal Voltage Undervoltage Dropout Adj Range Line Voltage Max. 120VAC 85 to 130VAC 143VAC 240VAC 170 to 240VAC 270VAC 380VAC 310 to 410VAC 480VAC 480VAC 350 to 480VAC 530VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABC Response Times Pull-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 400ms Drop-out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 100ms Hysterisis Pull-in/Drop-out. . . . . ≅ 2% Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay, energized when all voltages are acceptable Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A resistive @ 240VAC, 1/4 Hp @ 120VAC Maximum Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level B Isolation Voltage 120 & 240VAC.≥ 1500V RMS input to output 380 & 480VAC.≥ 2500V RMS input to output Mechanical Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin, plug-in Environmental Operating/ Storage Temperature. . . . . 0° to 55°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) *CAUTION: Select an octal socket rated for 600VAC operation. 117 Voltage Monitors PLS Series The PLS Series is a low cost phase sensitive control that provides an isolated contact closure when the proper A-B-C phase sequence is applied. Protects sensitive 3-phase equipment and equipment operators from reverse rotation. Designed to be compatible with motor overloads or other 3-phase equipment protection devices. Protection for equipment control centers where frequent reconnection or electrical code makes reverse rotation protection essential. Examples include: mobile refrigerated containers, construction equipment, hoists, pumps, conveyors, elevators and escalators. Features: For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 19 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 168, Figure 13 for connection diagram. Auxilary Products: Operation The internal relay and LED are energized when the phase sequence is correct. The output relay will not energize if the phases are reversed. Reset is automatic upon correction of the fault. •Protects against phase reversal •Low cost protection, one unit for all sized motors •3-wire connection for dela or wye systems •Octal base connect - industry standard wiring •Isolated, SPDT output contacts •Factory calibrated - no adjustments required Approvals: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: OT08PC • 3-phase fuse block/disconnect: P/N: FH3P • 2 Amp fuse: P/N: P0600-11 • Din rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Available Models: PLS120A PLS240A PLS480A Order Table: Voltage 120VAC 208/240VAC 380/415VAC 440/480VAC Part Number PLS120A PLS240A PLS380A PLS480A Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-phase delta or wye with no connection to neutral Nominal Voltage Minimum Voltage Maximum Voltage 120VAC 95VAC 135VAC 208/240VAC 175VAC 255VAC 380/415VAC 310VAC 430VAC 440/480VAC 380VAC 500VAC AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Phase Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABC Response Times Pull-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 300ms Drop-out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 50ms Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay, energized when the phase sequence is correct Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT Rating 120 & 240VAC . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC 380 & 480VAC . . . . . . 8A resistive @ 240VAC 118 Maximum Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Isolation Voltage 120 & 240VAC . . . . 380 & 480VAC . . . . Mechanical Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC ≥ 1500V RMS input to output ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Plug-in socket 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40°to 55°C / -40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) *CAUTION: Select an octal socket rated for 600VAC operation. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Voltage Monitors HLV Series The HLV Series is a single-phase undervoltage monitor designed to protect sensitive equipment from brownout or undervoltage conditions. Time delays are included to prevent nuisance tripping and short cycling. The 30A, 1hp rated, SPDT relay contacts allow direct control of motors, solenoids and valves. The output relay can be ordered with isolated SPDT contact to allow monitoring of one voltage and switching a separate voltage. Two undervoltage trip point ranges allow monitoring of 110 to 120VAC or 208 to 240VAC systems. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 2 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 15 for connection diagram. Operation Upon application of input voltage the output relay remains de-energized. When the input voltage value is above the pull-in voltage, the restart delay begins. At the end of the restart delay, the output relay energizes. When the input voltage falls below the trip point, the trip delay begins. If the input voltage remains below the pull-in voltage for the entire trip delay the relay de-energizes. If the input voltage returns to a value above the pull-in voltage, during the trip delay, the trip delay is reset and the relay remains energized. If the input voltage falls below the trip point voltage during the restart delay, the delay is reset and the relay remains de-energized. Reset is automatic upon correction of an undervoltage fault. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output relay and the time delays. Features: •Protects against undervoltage in singlephase systems •30A, SPDT, NO output contacts •100 to 240VAC input voltage •70 to 220VAC adjustable undervoltage trip point in 2 ranges •Restart delays from 3 - 300s •Trip delay 1 - 20s fixed •Isolated or non-isolated relay contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: HLVA6I23 PI TP V C-NO C-NC If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. IV tr = Restart Delay td = Trip Delay PI = Pull-in 105% or trip point TP = Trip Point V = Monitored Voltage IV = Input voltage C-NO = Normally Open Contacts C-NC = Normally Closed Contacts Order Table: HLVA X Undervoltage Range ─4 ─ - 70 to 120VAC ─6 ─ - 170 to 220VAC X Output Connection ─I─ - Isolated SPDT ─N ─ - Non-Isolated SPDT X Restart Delay ─2 ─ - Onboard adjustment 3-300s X Trip Delay ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 1-20s in 1s increments Specifications Input Min & Max RMS Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Undervoltage Sensing Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ranges (4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . (6). . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pull-In Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip Point Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay Restart Delays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance (Factory Calibration). . . . . . . . . . . Reset Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay vs. Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 to 264VAC 50/60 Hz AC ≤ 4VA Peak voltage sensing 70 to 120VAC 170 to 220VAC 105% or trip point voltage ± 3% of trip point 3 - 300s adjustable 1 - 20s fixed in 1s increments ±0.5% or 20ms, whichever is greater ±5% ≤ 150ms ≤ ±10% Electromechanical relay SPDT www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT-N.O SPDT-NC General Purpose 125/240VAC 30A 15A Resistive 125/240VAC 30A 15A 28VDC 20A 10A Motor Load 125VAC 1 hp* 1/4 hp** 240VAC 2 hp** 1 hp** Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106 Electrical - 1 x 105, *3 x104, **6,000 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output; isolated units Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 2 x 1.5 in. (76.7 x 51.3 x 38.1 mm) Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connects Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature.. . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 119 Voltage Monitors KVM Series The KVM Series is a single-phase undervoltage monitor designed to protect sensitive equipment against brownout undervoltage conditions. The compact design and encapsulated construction make the KVM an excellent choice for OEM equipment. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 1 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 16 for connection diagram. Operation The output relay is energized and the LED glows green when the input voltage is above the reset voltage threshold. If the input voltage drops below the undervoltage setpoint, the output relay and LED will de-energize. The output relay will remain de-energized as long as the input voltage is below the reset voltage. Reset is automatic when the input voltage returns to a normal range. Features: •Economical single-phase brownout/ undervoltage protection •Isolated, 8A, SPDT output contacts •Protects sensitive 110 to 120VAC or 220 to 240VAC loads •Adjustable low voltage trip point •LED Indicator Approvals: Auxilary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: KVM4 KVM6 TP = Undervoltage Setpoint R = Reset Point Order Table: Undervoltage Setpoint 78 to 99VAC 156 to 199VAC Maximum Line Voltage 132VAC 264VAC Part Number KVM4 KVM6 Specifications Line Voltage Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single phase Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 to 120VAC or 220 to 240VAC AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5W @ 132VAC; 4.5W @ 264VAC Power Off Reset Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . < 150ms Undervoltage Detection Undervoltage Setpoint KVM4. . . . . . 78 to 99VAC KVM6. . . . . . 156 to 199VAC Undervoltage Reset Point KVM4. . . . . . Fixed at 104VAC KVM6. . . . . . Fixed at 209VAC Repeatability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ± 0.5% under fixed conditions ±1% over temperature range Voltage Sensing Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±2% at 25°C Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPDT Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8A resistive @ 120VAC, 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC 120 Life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED Indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 5 Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; Electrical - 1x10 Glows green when output is energized IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Encapsulated > 1500V RMS input to output > 100 MΩ minimum Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -25 to 55°C / -40 to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Series Included Over or Undercurrent Monitor ECSW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Current Transducer TCSA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 DCSA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Current Indicator LCS10T12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 LPM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Current Sensors & Monitors Over or Undercurrent ECS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 TCS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 121 Current Sensor ECS Series The ECS Series of single-phase AC current sensors is a universal, overcurrent or undercurrent sensing control. Its built-in toroidal sensor eliminates the inconvenience of installing a stand-alone current transformer. Includes onboard adjustments for current sensing mode, trip point, and trip delay. Detects over or undercurrent events like; locked rotor, loss of load, an open heater or lamp load, or proves an operation is taking place or has ended. Features: For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 20 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 17 for connection diagram. Auxiliary Products: Operation Input voltage must be supplied at all times for proper operation. When a fault is sensed throughout the trip delay, the output relay is energized. When the current returns to the normal run condition or zero, the output and the delay are reset. If a fault is sensed and then corrected before the trip delay is completed, the relay will not energize and the trip delay is reset to zero. Adjustment Select the desired function, over or under current sensing. Set the trip point and trip delay to approximate settings. Apply power to the ECS and the monitored load. Turn adjustment and watch the LED. LED will light; turn slightly in opposite direction until LED is off. Adjustment can be done while connected to the control circuitry if the trip delay is set at maximum. To increase sensitivity, multiple turns may be made through the ECS’s toroidal sensor. The trip point range is divided by the number of turns through the toroidal sensor to create a new range. When using an external CT, select a 2VA, 0-5A output CT rated for the current to be monitored. Select ECS adjustment range 0. Pass one secondary wire lead through the ECS toroid and connect the secondary leads together. NO = Normally Open Contact NC = Normally Closed Contact A = Sensing Delay On Start Up TD = Trip Delay •Toroidal through hole wiring •0.5 - 50A trip points •Adjustable or factory fixed trip delays •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •5% trip point hysteresis (dead band) Approvals: • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: ECS20BC ECSH21F.08C ECS21BC ECSH30AC ECS21BH ECSH3HF0.08D ECS2HBC ECSH40AC ECS30AC ECSH40AD ECS40A ECSH41AD ECS40AC ECSH41BC ECS40BC ECSH41F.08D ECS40BD ECSH4HF.08D ECS41A ECSH61AD ECS41AC ECSL31A ECS41BC ECSL40AC ECS41BD ECSL40B ECS41BH ECSL40BH ECS41F.08 ECSL41A ECS4HBC ECSL41AD ECS4HBH ECSL45F7 ECS60AH ECSL4HBH ECS60BC ECSL61AH ECS61BC ECSL6HAC ECS6HAH If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. TP = Trip Point R = Reset OC = Monitored Current Order Table: X Series ─ECS ─ - Selectable over or undercurrent sensing ─ECSH ─ - Overcurrent sensing ─ECSL ─ - Undercurrent sensing X Input ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Trip Point ─Fixed ─ - Specify 2-50A in 1A increments ─0 ─ - 0.5-5A adjustable ─1 ─ - 2-20A adjustable ─H ─ - 5-50A adjustable X Trip Delay ─F ─ - Specify: 0.08-50s factory fixed ─A ─ - 0.150-7s adjustable ─B ─ - 0.5-50s adjustable X Sensing Delay on Start Up ─Blank ─ - 0s ─C ─ - 1s ─D ─ - 2s ─E ─ - 3s ─F ─ - 4s ─G ─ - 5s ─H ─ - 6s Specifications Sensor Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Toroidal through hole wiring Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Over or undercurrent, switch selectable on the unit or factory fixed Trip Point Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 - 50A in 3 adjustable ranges or fixed Tolerance Adjustable. . . . . . . Guaranteed range Fixed . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 - 25A: 0.5A or ±5% whichever is less; 26 - 50A: ±2.5% Maximum Allowable Current. . . . . . . . Steady – 50A turns; Inrush – 300A turns for 10s Trip Point Hysteresis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ ±5% Trip Point vs. Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . ±5% Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 75ms Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45/500 Hz Type of Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peak detection Trip Delay Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog Range Adjustable . . . . . . . 0.150 - 7s; 0.5 - 50s (guaranteed ranges) Factory Fixed . . . . 0.08 - 50s (±20ms, whichever is greater) Delay vs. Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±15% Sensing Delay on Startup. . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed 0 - 6s: +40%, -0% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 , 120, or 230VAC; 12 or 24VDC 122 Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC . . . 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . -15 - 20% -20 - 10% 50/60 Hz Electromechanical relay Isolated, SPDT 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical – 1 x 106 ; Electrical – 1 x 105 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.75 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 44.5 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals (5) Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6.4 oz (181 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Current Sensors ECSW Series The ECSW Series of single-phase, AC window, current sensors includes adjustable overcurrent and undercurrent trip points. Detects locked rotor, jam, loss of load, an open heater or lamp load, a broken belt, or loss of suction. LED’s aid in trip point adjustment and provide fault indication. The built-in toroidal sensor eliminates the need for an external current transformer. The output can be electrically latched after a fault, or automatically reset. Remote resetting of a latched output by removing input voltage. The unit includes switch selectable zero current detection and normally de-energized or energized output operation. Time delays are included to improve operation and eliminate nuisance tripping. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 20 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 18 for connection diagram. Features: •Overcurrent & undercurrent (window current) sensing •Adjustable overcurrent & undercurrent trip points •Current sensor is included •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts •LED indicators Approvals: Available Models: ECSW3LABT ECSW4HBHT ECSW4LABT ECSW4LBHT ECSW4MBHT If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Operation When the input voltage is applied, sensing delay on startup begins and the output transfers (if normally energized is selected). Upon completion of the startup delay, sensing of the monitored current begins. As long as current is above undercurrent trip point and below the overcurrent trip point (inside the window), the output relay remains in its normal operating condition and both red LED’s are OFF. The green LED glows when the output is energized. If current varies outside the window, the associated red LED glows, and the trip delay begins. If the current remains outside the window for the full trip delay, the relay transfers to fault condition state. If the current returns to normal levels (inside the window) during the trip delay, the red LED goes OFF, the trip delay is reset, and the output remains in the normal condition. Reset: Remove input voltage or open latch switch. If zero current detection is selected, the unit will reset as soon as zero current is detected. Operation With Zero Current Detection Enabled: If the current decreases to zero within the trip delay period, then zero current is viewed as an acceptable current level. The unit’s output remains in its normal operating state. This allows the monitored load to cycle ON and OFF without nuisance tripping the ECSW. Zero current is defined as current flow of less than 250 milliamp-turns. Note: When zero current detect is selected, the latching operation of switch SW2 is canceled; the output will not latch after a fault trip. Notes on Operation: 1) There is no hysteresis on the trip points. The overcurrent and undercurrent trip points should be adjusted to provide adequate protection against short cycling. 2) If the upper setpoint is set below the lower setpoint, both red LED’s will glow indicating a setting error. 3) If zero current detection is selected (SW2 ON), and the system is wired to disconnect the monitored load, the system may short cycle. After the unit trips, the load de-energizes, and zero current is detected. The ECSW resets, and the load energizes again immediately and may be short cycled. 4) The sensing delay on start up only occurs when input voltage is applied. When zero current detection is selected, the trip delay must be longer than the duration of the inrush current or the unit will trip on the inrush current. Typical Pump or Fan Protection Circuit Operation Window Current Sensing: With the ECSW connected as shown in the diagram, a load may be monitored and controlled for over and undercurrent. The ECSW Series’ on board CT (CS) may be placed on the line or load side of the contactor. The ECSW selection switches are set for zero current sensing (see Selector Switch SW2) and the output selection is normally de-energized (see Selector Switch SW3). The input voltage (V) is applied to the ECSW continually. As the control switch (FSW) is closed, the input voltage (V) is applied to the motor contactor coil (MCC), and the motor (M) energizes. As long as the current remains below the overcurrent and above the undercurrent trip points, the ECSW’s output contacts remain de-energized. If the load current should rise above or fall below a trip point, for the full trip delay, the normally open (NO) contact will close, energizing the control relay (CR) coil. The CR normally closed contact (CR1) opens and the MCC de-energizes and CR latches on through its normally open contacts (CR2). Reset is accomplished by momentarily opening the normally closed reset switch (RSW). Note: If the current falls to zero within the trip delay, the ECSW remains de-energized. The sensing delay on startup occurs when Selector Switch input voltage is applied therefore trip delay must be longer than the duration of the motor’s inrush current. The external latching relay CR2 is required in this system to prevent rapid cycling. A timer can be added to provide an automatic reset. ON OFF Order Table: ECSW X Input ─1 ─ - 12VDC ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─3 ─ - 24VDC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Trip Point ─L ─ - 0.5-5A adjustable ─M ─ - 2-20A adjustable ─H ─ - 5-50A adjustable X Trip Delay ─F ─ - Specify: 0.1-50s factory fixed* ─A ─ - 0.150-7s adjustable ─B ─ - 0.5-50s adjustable *If fixed delay is selected, insert delay (0.1-50) in seconds. 0.1-1.9s in 0.1s increments; 2-50s in 1s increments. X SensingDelay on Start up ─B ─ - 0.1s ─C ─ - 1s ─D ─ - 2s ─E ─ - 3s ─F ─ - 4s ─G ─ - 5s ─H ─ - 6s X Connection ─T ─ - Terminal Blocks SW1 SW2 SW3 Not Used Latched Zero I Output - Normally Energized Mode Selection Switches SW1 = Latched or Auto reset selector OFF - Automatic reset after a fault ON - Output relay latches after a fault trips the unit SW2 = Zero current detection (below 250 mA) OFF- Zero current detection disabled ON- Zero current detection enabled SW3 = Output during normal operation OFF- Output relay de-energized ON - Output relay energized Specifications Mode: Switch selectable ON . . . . . . Energized during normal operation, de-energized Sensor after a fault Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Toroid, through hole wiring for up to #4 AWG (21.1 mm2) OFF. . . . . . De-energized during normal operation, energizes THHN wire during a fault Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Over & undercurrent trip points (window current sensing) Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Trip Point Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 - 50A in 3 adjustable ranges Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Guaranteed range 1/2 hp @ 250VAC Maximum Allowable Current. . . . . . . . Steady - 50A turns; Inrush - 300A turns for 10s Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 106; Electrical - 1 x 105 Time Point vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . ±5% Latch Type . . . . . . . Electrical Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 75ms Reset. . . . . . . Remove input voltage Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45/500 Hz Function. . . . Switch selectable latching function Type of Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peak detection Protection Zero Current Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . < 250mA turns typical Surge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Time Delay Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.15 - 50s in 2 adjustable ranges or 0.1 - 50s fixed Isolation Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable: guaranteed range; Fixed: ±10% Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Sensing Delay On Start Up. . . . . . . . . . . Fixed ≅ 0.1 - 6s in 1s increments Mechanical Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +40% -0% Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Delay vs. Temperature & Voltage. . . . . ±15% Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.75 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 44.5 mm) Input Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.197 in. (5 mm) terminal blocks for up to #12 Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC; 12 or 24VDC (3.2 mm2) AWG wire Tolerance 12VDC & 24VDC/AC. . . . -15% - 20% Environmental 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . . . . . -20% - 10% Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60° C/-40° to 85° C AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Humidity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Output Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6.4 oz (181 g) Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 123 Current Sensor TCS Series The TCS Series is a low cost method of go/no go current detection. It includes a solid-state output to sink or source current when connected directly to a standard PLC digital input module. Its normally open or normally closed output can also be used to control relays, lamps, valves, and small heaters rated up to 1A steady, 10A inrush. The TCS is selfpowered (no external power required to operate the unit) and available with an adjustable actuation range of 2 - 20A or factory fixed actuation points from 2 - 45A. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 21 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 19 for connection diagram. Features: •Direct connection to a PLC digital input module •3 to 50VDC, 24 to 240VAC •1A steady - 10A inrush •Actuation Points – 2 - 45A (fixed units) 2 - 20A (adjustable units) •NO or NC solid-state output •Complete isolation between sensed current & control circuit Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Operation Normally Open: When a current equal to or greater than the actuate current is passed through the toroidal sensor, the output closes. When the current is reduced to 95% of the actuate current or less, the output opens. Normally Closed: When the current through the toroid is equal to or greater than the actuate current, the output opens. When the current is reduced below 95% of the actuate current, the output closes. To increase sensitivity, multiple turns may be made through the TCS’s toroidal sensor. The trip point range is divided by the number of turns through the toroidal sensor to create a new range. When using an external CT, select a 2VA, 0-20A output CT rated for the current to be monitored. Select TCS adjustment range 0. Pass one secondary wire lead through the TCS’ toroid and connect the secondary leads together. • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) • DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TCSG2A TCSGAA TCSGAB TCSH2A TCSH2B TCSH3A TCSH4A TCSHAA TCSHAB If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. L = Load V = Voltage PS = Power Supply PLC = PLC Digital Input Module R = Reset TP = Trip Point OC = Monitored Current NO = Normally Open Output NC = Normally Closed Output Order Table: TCS X Output Voltage ─G ─ - 3-50VDC ─H ─ - 24-240VAC X Actuate Current ─A ─ - 2-20A adjustable ─Fixed ─ - Specify from 2-45A in 1A increments X Output Form ─A ─ - Normally Open ─B ─ - Normally Closed Specifications Sensor Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Toroid, through hole wiring, alternating current, monitored wire must be properly insulated Current to Actuate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable: - 2 - 20A, guaranteed range Fixed: - 2 - 45A, +0/-20% Reset Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 95% of the actuate current Maximum Allowable Current. . . . . . . . . . . . Steady - 50A turns Inrush - 300A turns for 10s Actuate Current vs. Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . ≤ ±5% Response Times. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overcurrent - ≤ 200ms Undercurrent - ≤ 1s Burden. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . < 0.5VA Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NO or NC Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A steady, 10A inrush Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC - 24 to 240VAC +10/-20% DC - 3 to 50VDC Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC NO & NC - ≅ 2.5V DC NO & NC - ≅ 1.2V 124 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.75 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 44.5 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals (2) Sensor Hole. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.36 in. (9.14 mm) for up to #4 AWG 2 (21.1 mm ) THHN wire Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.6 oz (74 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Current Transducers TCSA Series 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 0 1 2 4 10 2 4 8 20 3 6 12 30 5 10 20 50 4 8 16 40 The TCSA Series is a loop-powered, linear output current transducer that provides an output that is directly proportional to the RMS AC current passing through the onboard toroid. The TCSA provides a 4 - 20mA output over a power supply range of 10 - 30VDC. Each unit is factory calibrated for monitoring in one of four ranges; 0-5, 0-10, 0-20, or 0-50A. The 0 - 5A range allows the use of external current transformers so loads up to 1200AC amps can be monitored. Features: For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 21 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 20 for connection diagram. Auxilary Products: Operation The TCSA varies the effective resistance of its output in direct proportion to the current flowing in the monitored conductor. The unit is factory calibrated so that 0 amps provides a 4mA output and full span provides a 20mA output. Zero and span adjustments are provided for minor calibration adjustments in the field (if required). Using an External Current Transformer (CT) Select a 2VA, 0 to 5A output CT, rated for the current to be monitored. Select TCSA5. Pass one of the CT’s secondary wire leads through the TCSA’s toroid. Connect the CT’s secondary leads together. 20 18 •Monitors 0 - 50A in 4 ranges •Loop powered from 10 to 30VDC •Linear output from 4 - 20mA •Zero & span adjustments •Complete isolation between sensed current & control circuit Approvals: •Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) •Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 •Mounting bracket: P/N: P1023-6 •DIN rail: P/N: C103PM •DIN rail adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Available Models: TCSA5 TCSA10 TCSA20 TCSA50 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 0 1 2 4 10 2 4 8 20 3 6 12 30 4 8 16 40 5 10 20 50 Order Table: Current Range 0-5A 0-10A 0-20A 0-50A Part Number TCSA5 TCSA10 TCSA20 TCSA50 Specifications Sensor Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Toroid, through hole wiring, alternating current, monitored conductor must be properly insulated Monitored AC Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 - 50A Ranges 4 factory calibrated ranges. . . . 0 - 5A, 0 - 10A, 0 - 20A, or 0 - 50A Factory calibration. . . . . . . . . . . ≤±2% of full scale Maximum Allowable Current. . . . . . . . . . . . Steady – 50A turns; Inrush – 300A turns for 10s Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤±0.25% of full scale under fixed conditions Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 300ms Burden. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 0.5VA AC Line Frequency 0 - 20A / 21 - 50A. . . . 20 - 100Hz / 30 - 100Hz Temperature Coefficient. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.05%/°C Output Type: Series Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Current directly proportional to monitored current Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 20mA Sensor Supply Voltage*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 to 30VDC Momentary Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40VDC for 1m Zero Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.75 - 4.25mA Span Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18mA - 22mA Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini-screw, 25-turn potentiometer Protection Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Units are reverse polarity protected Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.75 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 44.5 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Sensor Hole. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.36 in. (9.14 mm) for up to #4 AWG (21.1 mm2) THHN wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . -30° to 60°C/-40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) *Minimum loop-power supply voltage equals the minimum sensor voltage 10VDC plus the voltage drop developed across all the other loop devices at 20mA. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 125 Current Transducers DCSA Series The DCSA Series is a loop-powered, linear output current transducer that provides an output that is directly proportional to the RMS AC current passing through the LCSC10T12 sensor. The DCSA provides either an analog current or voltage: 4 - 20 mA, 1 to 5VDC, or 2 to 10VDC. Each unit is factory calibrated for monitoring (with the LCSC10T12 connected) in one of four ranges; 0 - 5, 0 - 10, 0 - 20, or 0 - 50A. Zero and span adjustments allow field calibration if needed. The DCSA mounts on both DIN 1 and DIN 3 rails. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 22 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 169, Figure 21 for connection diagram. Operation The DCSA varies the effective resistance of its output in direct proportion to the current flowing in the conductor monitored by the LCSC10T12. Connecting the power supply to terminals C & D provides a 4 to 20mA DC current. Connect the power supply to terminals C & A to get 1 to 5VDC at terminal D. Connect the power supply to terminals C & B to get 2 to 10VDC at terminal D. Features: •Mounts on DIN 1 or DIN 3 rail •0 - 50A in 4 ranges using LCSC10T12 sensor •Loop powered from 10 to 30VDC •Linear output from 4 - 20mA, 1 - 10VD •Zero & span adjustments •Separate sensor & control unit Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Current sensor: P/N: LCSC10T12 Available Models: DCSA50 LCSC10T12 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Monitored Current Amps 50, 20, 10, 5 25, 10, 5, 2.5 A 0 mA 4 VDC 2 Output 1 12 6 3 20 10 5 Order Table: Current Range with LCSC10T12 0-5A 0-10A 0-20A 0-50A DCSA Input Range (F to E) 0-5mA AC 0-10mA AC 0-20mA AC 0-50mA AC Toroidal Current Sensor Part Number DCSA5 DCSA10 DCSA20 DCSA50 LCSC10T12 Specifications Input Ranges (without LCSC10T12 connected) 4 factory calibrated ranges in mA AC. . . . . . . . . . 0 - 5mA, 0 - 10mA, 0 - 20mA, or 0 - 50mA AC Factory calibration. . . . . . . . . . ±0.5% of full scale Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.25% of full scale under fixed conditions Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 300ms Temperature Coefficient. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±0.05%/°C Input To Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Not isolated Output Type Analog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Current directly proportional to input current Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 20mA, or 1 to 5VDC or 2 to 10VDC Supply Voltage*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 to 30VDC Momentary Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40VDC for 1m Zero Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.75 - 4.25mA Span Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18mA - 22mA Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini-screw, multi-turn potentiometer Protection Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100 MΩ Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Units are reverse polarity protected 126 Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DIN 1 & DIN 3 rail mounting Termination Wire clamp . . . . . . . . . . . For 22 - 14AWG (.336 mm2 ... 2.5 mm2) Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . -30° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 1.6 oz (45.4 g) Accessory - LCSC10T12 Toroidal Sensor Number of Turns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1000 Nominal Output Current Full Range. . . . . . . . . 0 - 50 mA Maximum Allowable Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Steady 50A turns Inrush 300A turns for 10s Burden. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 0.5 VA Frequency 0 - 20A / 21 - 50A . . . . . . . . . . 20/100 Hz / 30/100 Hz Sensor Hole. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.36 in. (9.14 mm) for up to #4 AWG (21.1 mm2) THHN wire Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 1 oz (28.3 g) *Minimum loop-power supply voltage equals the minimum sensor voltage 10VDC plus the voltage drop developed across all the other loop devices at 20mA. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Current Indicators LCS10T12 / LPM The LCS10T12 connected to the LPM12 or LPMG12 indicator is a low cost, easy to use, go/no-go indication system for the remote monitoring of current flow. The LCS10T12 is installed on an adequately insulated wire of the monitored load. Its 12in. (30.4cm) leads are connected to the LPM12 or LPMG12 panel mount indicator directly or via customer supplied wires up to 500 feet (152.4m) long. For more information see: Appendix B, pages 166 & 167, Figures 23 & 24 for dimensional drawings. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 22 for connection diagram. Features: •Low cost go/no go indication •May be connected to wires up to 500 feet (152.4 m) long •Remote monitoring of currents up to 50A •Green or red LED indicator available Approvals: Available Models: LCS10T12 LPM12 LPMG12 Operation When the monitored current is 5A turns, the panel mount LPM indicator will glow. The LCS10T12 is designed to maximize the light output of the panel mount indicator. It can be used to monitor current flow of less than 5A by passing the monitored conductor 2 or more times through the sensor. CAUTION: The LCS10T12 must be connected to the LPM12 or LPMG12 before current flows to prevent damage or a shock hazard. Monitored wires must be properly insulated. Panel mount indicator designed to match the output of the LCS10T12. The LPM12 and LPMG12 come with 12 in. (30.4 cm) wires and a one piece mounting clip. Both devices install quickly in a 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) hole in panels from 0.031 - 0.062 in. (0.79 - 1.6 mm) thick. Order Table: Description AC Current Sensor Red LED Indicator Green LED Indicator Part Number LCS10T12 LPM12 LPMG12 Specifications Monitored Current Current Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 50A AC Wire Passes Min. Current Max Current Max. Inrush Max. Wire Dia. 1 5A 50A 120A 0.355 in. (9.0 mm) 2 2.5A 25A 60A 0.187 in. (4.7 mm) 3 1.7A 16.6A 40A 0.15 in. (3.8 mm) 4 1.3A 12.5A 30A 0.125 in. (3.2 mm) 5 5/X 50/X 120/X Maximum Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50A turns continuous AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz DC Resistance of Current Limiter. . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Ω Mechanical Sensor Hole. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.36 in. (9.14 mm) for up to #4 AWG (21.1 mm2) THHN wire Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 in. (30.4 cm) wire leads Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C/-40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCS: ≅ 0.8 oz (23 g) LPM: ≅ 0.2 oz (6 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 127 Series Included Open Board LLC1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 LLC2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Octal Plug-in LLC4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 LLC5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Liquid Level Controls & Alternating Relays 128 Low Level Cut Off LLC6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 LLC8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Alternating Relays ARP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Liquid Level Controls LLC1 Series The LLC1 Series is a single probe conductive liquid level control designed for OEM equipment and commercial appliances. This unit may be ordered with selectable or fixed fill or drain operation. A time delay (1-60s) prevents rapid cycling of the output relay. On adjustable units, the sensitivity adjustment allows accurate level sensing while ignoring foaming agents and floating debris. Isolated AC voltage is provided at the probe to prevent electrolysis. A trickle current of less than 1mA determines the presence or absence of liquid between the probe and common. The LLC1 Series printed circuit board is conformal coated to resist moisture and corrosion. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 26 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 23 for connection diagram. Operation Drain (Pump-Down Mode): When the liquid level rises and touches the probe, a fixed time delay begins. This time delay prevents rapid cycling of the output relay and its load. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until the liquid level falls below the probe. The output relay then de-energizes and remains de-energized until the liquid again touches the probe. Fill (Pump-Up Mode): When the liquid level falls below the probe, a fixed time delay begins. This time delay prevents rapid cycling of the output relay and its load. At the end of the time delay, the output relay energizes and remains energized until the liquid level rises and touches the probe. The output relay then de-energizes and remains de-energized until the liquid level again falls below the probe. Features: •Single probe level control for conductive liquids •Isolated AC voltage on the probes •Adjustable or fixed sensing up to 250KΩ •Fill or drain operation available •24, 120, or 230VAC models are available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT & non-isolated, SPST output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: LLC14A1AX LLC14A5AX LLC14A7AX LLC14B15AX LLC14B1AX LLC14B60AX LLC16A25AX LLC16A3AX LLC16B60A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC1 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Operation ─A ─ - Drain ─B ─ - Fill X Time Delay ─Fixed: ─ Specify 1-60s in 1s increments X Sense Resistance ─A ─ - Adjustable ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance (1-250) in 1KΩ increments.) X Mounting ─Blank ─ - Surface mount ─X ─ - 0.5 in. nylon standoffs (three) Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF (single level) resistance sensor with built-in time delay to prevent rapid cycling Sense Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low voltage AC between probe & common. Isolated from input & output. Sense Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed or adjustable to 250KΩ Sense Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable - guaranteed range Factory fixed ±10% Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed 1 - 60s in 1s increments Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated, SPST & Isolated, SPDT contacts Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 105 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input, output & probe Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount to probe common with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws or 0.50 in. (12.7 mm) nylon standoffs with three #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws (use Terminal 5 for probe common) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Dimensions (Open Board) . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.75 x 2 in. (88.9 x 69.9 x 50.8 mm) Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . -20° to 55°C/-40° to 80°C Coating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Printed circuit board is conformal coated to resist moisture and corrosion Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 8.7 oz (247 g) 129 Liquid Level Controls LLC2 Series The LLC2 Series is a dual-probe conductive liquid level control designed for OEM equipment and commercial appliance applications. Models are available for fill or drain operation. Transformer isolated 12VAC is provided at the probes to prevent electrolysis. A trickle current of less than 1mA determines the presence or absence of liquid between the probes and common. On adjustable units, the sensitivity adjustment allows accurate level sensing while ignoring foaming agents and floating debris. The LLC2 Series printed circuit board is conformal coated to resist moisture and corrosion. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 27 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 27 for connection diagram. Operation Drain (Pump-Down Mode): When the liquid level rises and touches the high probe, the output relay energizes and remains energized until the liquid level falls below the low probe. The output relay then de-energizes and remains de-energized until the liquid again touches the high probe. Fill (Pump-Up Mode): When the liquid level falls below the low probe, the output relay energizes and remains energized until the liquid level rises and touches the high probe. The output relay then de-energizes and remains de-energized until the liquid level again falls below the low probe. Features: •Dual probe level control for conductive liquids •Isolated AC voltage on the probes •Adjustable or fixed sensing up to 100KΩ •Terminal block or quick connect terminals •Fill or drain operation available •24, 120, or 230VAC models are available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: LLC24A2AN LLC24A2F50N LLC24B2F50N LLC26A1F25C If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC2 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Operation ─A ─ - Drain ─B ─ - Fill X Termination ─1 ─ - 0.25 Quick Connect ─2 ─ - Terminal Block X Sense Resistance ─A ─ - Adjustable to 100kΩ ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance 1-100 in 1KΩ increments.) X Mounting Dimension ─N ─ ─C ─ N C W 0.44 (11.35) 0.25 (6.35) X 3.62 (11.35) 3.5 (88.9) Y 2.12 (53.8) 2.5 (63.5) Z 0.19 (4.83) 0.25 (6.35) Mounting dimensions as indicated in Appendix B, page 167. Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Resistance sensing for high & low level detection of conductive liquids Sense Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12VAC at probe terminals Sense Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed or adjustable to 100KΩ Sense Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustable: guaranteed range Fixed: ±10% Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC 5 7 Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 10 ; Electrical - 1 x 10 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input, output, & probe 130 Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two or four #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) duplex male quick connect terminals Terminal blocks for up to #14 AWG (2.5 mm2) wire Dimensions (Open Board) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x 3 x 2 in. (101.6 x 76.2 x 50.8 mm) Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . -20° to 55°C / -40° to 80°C Coating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Printed circuit board is conformal coated to resist moisture and corrosion Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 9 oz (255 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Liquid Level Controls LLC4 Series The LLC4 combines resistance sensing circuitry with solid-state timing to provide single probe level maintenance. On adjustable units, the sensitivity adjustment allows accurate level sensing while ignoring foaming agents and floating debris. Isolated pulsed DC is provided at the probe to prevent electrolysis. A trickle current of less than 1mA determines the presence or absence of conductive liquid between the probe and common. The LLC4 Series can be used with many types of low voltage (resistance changing) transducers to perform other control functions like temperature limit control, photo limit control, condensation sensing, and ice sensing. Features: For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 19 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 24 for connection diagram. • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) Operation Drain (Pump-Down Mode): When the liquid level rises and touches the probe, the time delay begins. This time delay prevents rapid cycling of the output relay and its load. At the end of the time delay, the output relay and LED energize and remain energized until the liquid level falls below the probe level. The output relay and LED de-energize and remain de-energized until the liquid rises and touches the probe. Fill (Pump-Up Mode): When the liquid level falls below the probe, the time delay begins. This time delay prevents rapid cycling of the output relay and its load. At the end of the time delay, the output relay and LED energize and remain energized until the liquid level rises and touches the probe. The output relay and LED then de-energize and remain de-energized until the liquid level again falls below the probe level. •Single probe level control for conductive liquids •Adjustable or fixed sensing up to 250 KΩ •Selectable or fixed fill or drain operation available •24, 120, or 230VAC models are available •Isolated pulsed DC on the probes •Isolated, 4A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Available Models: LLC42A10A LLC42A1A LLC42B15A LLC44A10A LLC44A1A LLC44A2A LLC44A4A LLC44A5A LLC44A60A LLC44B1F250 LLC44B20A LLC44B2A LLC44B30A LLC44B4A LLC44B5A LLC44B5F100 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC4 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Operation ─A ─ - Drain ─B ─ - Fill X Time Delay ─Specify ─ fixed delay 1-60s in 1s increments X Sense Resistance ─A ─ - Adjustable (1-250k) ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance (1-250) in 1KΩ increments.) Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF (single level) resistance sensor with built-in time delay to prevent rapid cycling Sensing Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pulsed DC at probe terminals Sensing Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed or adjustable to 250KΩ Sensing Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . . . Adjustable: 1K ±500Ω at low end; 250K ±25% at high end Factory fixed: ±10% or 500Ω, whichever is greater Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . -15%, +20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . -20%, +10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/10 hp @ 240VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolation Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A ≥ 1500V RMS between input, output & probe Plug-in socket Octal 8-pin plug-in 2.91 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (73.9 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) -20° to 60°C/-40° to 80°C ≅ 6 oz (170 g) 131 Liquid Level Controls LLC5 Series The LLC5 provides dual probe conductive liquid level control in a convenient octal plugin package. Models are available for fixed fill or drain operation. Isolated, pulsed DC voltage on the probes prevents electrolytic plating. Less than 1 mA of current is used to sense the presence of conductive liquid between the probes and common. On adjustable units, the sensitivity adjustment eliminates false tripping caused by floating debris and foaming agents. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 29 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 28 for connection diagram. Operation Drain (Pump-Down Mode): When the liquid level rises and touches the high level probe, the output relay and LED energize and remain energized until the liquid level falls below the low level probe. The output relay and LED de-energize and remain de-energized until the liquid rises and touches the high level probe. Fill (Pump-Up Mode): When the liquid level falls below the low level probe, the output relay and LED energize and remain energized until the liquid level rises and touches the high level probe. The output relay and LED de-energize and remain de-energized until the liquid level again falls below the low level probe. Features: •Dual probe level control for conductive liquids •Onboard knob or fixed sensing up to 100KΩ •Fill or drain operation available •Select standard or diagnostic LED operation •Diagnostic LED operation reduces adjustment & troubleshooting time •24, 120, or 230VAC models are available •Isolated, 5A, SPDT ouput contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • Octal 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 Available Models: LLC52AA LLC52BA LLC54AA LLC54AAS LLC54AF10 LLC54BA LLC54BAS LLC56AA If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC5 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Operation ─A ─ - Drain ─B ─ - Fill X Sense Resistance ─A ─ - Adjustable ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance 1-100 in 1KΩ increments.) X Connection ─Blank ─ - Standard (#6 Low, #8 High) ─S ─ - Reverse (#8 Low, #6 High) X LED Operation ─Blank ─ - Standard LED operation ─D ─ - LED operation with diagnostics Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Resistance sensing for high & low level detection of conductive liquids Sensing Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pulsed DC at probe terminals Sensing Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Factory fixed or adjustable to 100KΩ Sensing Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . Adjustable: 1K ±500Ω at low end; 100KΩ ±25%, 0% at high end Factory fixed: ±10% or 500Ω whichever is greater Response Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Debounce time delay <1s Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . -15%, +20% 120 & 230VAC. . . . . -20%, +10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz 132 Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A resistive @ 240VAC 1/10 hp @ 240VAC Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS between input, output, & probe Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.01 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (76.5 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Octal 8-pin plug-in Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 80°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6 oz (170 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Liquid Level Controls LLC6 Series The LLC6 Series is a plug-in, single-probe conductive liquid level control designed for low liquid level cutoff protection. It offers a factory fixed time delay of 1 - 60s and is available in input voltages of 24, 120, or 230VAC. LED indicator illuminates whenever the LLC6’s 10A, SPDT output relay is energized. Available with automatic/manual reset or a special manual reset with power outage feature, which auto resets the unit when power is restored and the water level is acceptable. 24VAC and 120VAC units are recognized as limit switches under UL353 (230VAC units are UL508) and CSA certified under Standard 14. For more information see: Appendix B, page 166, Figure 19 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 26 for connection diagram. Operation Automatic Reset (Reset terminals not connected): When liquid rises to the low level cutoff probe, the output relay and the LED indicator energize. When the liquid falls below low level cutoff probe, the output relay and the LED indicator de-energize after a fixed time delay. Manual Reset (Reset switch connected): When the liquid level falls below the low level probe, the output relay and LED de-energize after a fixed time delay. When the liquid level rises to the low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator remain de-energized until the manual reset switch is opened; then they energize immediately. Power Outage Manual Reset (Reset switch connected): A power outage causes the output relay and LED indicator to de-energize. Upon restoration of power, if the liquid level is above the low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator will re-energize. If the liquid level is below the low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator remain de-energized until the Normally Closed (NC) reset switch is opened. Features: •Designed for low level cutoff protection •Energized on wet probe •Fixed time delay of 1 - 60s •Fixed sense resistance of 5K - 250KΩ •24, 120, or 230VAC input voltage available •Non-isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) Available Models: LLC6210F10M LLC622F10P LLC6410F10M LLC642F10M LLC643F250M LLC645F250M LLC6610F5P If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC6 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Time Delay (fixed) ─Specify ─ fixed delay in seconds (1-60) in 1s increments X Sense Resistance ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance in kilohms (5-250) in 1K increments.) X Reset ─M ─ - Manual/Automatic Reset ─P ─ - Power outage manual reset Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ON/OFF (single level) resistance sensor with built-in time delay to prevent rapid cycling Sense Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12VAC nominal at probe terminals Sense Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed 5K - 250KΩ Sense Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed ±10% Time Delay Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 60s in 1s increments Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±10% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . . . . . ±10% Power Outage Reset Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 1s Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC . . . . . . . +20% to -15% 120 or 230VAC . . . . . . +10% to -20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated, SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 240VAC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS between input & output terminals Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug-in socket Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-pin relay type Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.91 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (73.9 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 80°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 7.3 oz (207 g) 133 Liquid Level Controls LLC8 Series The LLC8 Series is a low cost, single-probe conductive liquid level control designed for low liquid level cutoff protection. It offers a factory fixed time delay of 1 - 60s and is available for input voltages of 24, 120, or 230VAC. LED indicator illuminates whenever the LLC8’s isolated, 10A, SPDT output relay is energized. Sense resistance is fixed from 5K - 250KΩ. Available with manual/ automatic reset or a special manual reset with a power outage feature that auto resets the unit when power is restored and the water level is acceptable. 24 and 120VAC units are UL recognized as limit switches under UL353 (230VAC units are UL 508) and CSA certified under Standard 14. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 28 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 170, Figure 25 for connection diagram. Operation Automatic Reset (Reset switch not connected): When liquid rises to low level cutoff probe, output relay and LED indicator energize. When liquid falls below the low level cutoff probe, the output relay and LED indicator de-energize after a fixed time delay. Manual Reset (Reset switch connected): When the liquid level falls below low level probe, the output relay and LED de-energize after a fixed time delay. When the liquid level rises to low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator remain de-energized until the NC manual reset switch is opened; then they energize immediately. Power Outage Manual Reset (Reset switch connected): A power outage causes the output relay and LED indicator to de-energize. Upon restoration of power, if the liquid is touching the low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator will re-energize. If the liquid level is below the low level probe, the output relay and LED indicator remain de-energized until the NC reset switch is opened. Features: •Designed for low level cutoff protection •Energized on wet probe •Fixed time delay 1 - 60s •Fixed sense resistance of 5K - 250KΩ •24, 120, or 230VAC input voltages available •Isolated, 10A, SPDT output contacts Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Electrode: P/N: PHST-38QTN • Threaded probe (24”): P/N: LLP-24 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: LLC825F5M LLC843F10M LLC843F10P LLC843F26M LLC843F26P LLC845F25P LLC8610F12M If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: LLC8 X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Time Delay (fixed) ─Specify ─ fixed delay in seconds (1-60) in 1s increments X Sense Resistance ─F ─ - Fixed (Specify fixed resistance in kilohms (5-250) in 1K increments.) X Reset ─M ─ - Manual/Automatic Reset ─P ─ - Power outage manual reset Specifications Control Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Resistance sensing for conductive liquids with time delay Sense Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12VAC nominal at probe terminals Sense Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed 5K - 250KΩ Sense Resistance Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . ±10% Time Delay Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% Repeat Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±10% Time Delay vs Temp. & Voltage. . . . . . ±10% Power Outage Reset Delay. . . . . . . . . . ≤1s Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . -15% - 20% 120 or 230VAC. . . . . . -20% - 10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60 Hz Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromechanical relay Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Isolated SPDT Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC 134 Protection Surge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEEE C62.41-1991 Level A Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2500V RMS input to output terminals Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 in. (12.7 mm) x .187 (4.76 mm) dia. nylon standoffs (3) Termination Electrical . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Reset Switch & Probe(s). . . . . . . 0.187 x 0.03 in. (4.75 x 0.76 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . -40° to 60°C / -40° to 80°C Coating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Printed circuit board is conformal coated to resist moisture & corrosion Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 5 oz (141.7 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Alternating Relay ARP Series The ARP Series is used in systems where equal run time for two motors is desirable. The selector switch allows selection of alternation of either load for continuous operation. LED’s indicate the status of the output relay. This versatile series may be front panel mounted (BZ1 accessory required) or 35 mm DIN rail mounted with an accessory socket. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 31 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, 170, Figure 29 for connection diagram. Features: •Provides equal run time for two motors •Alternating or electrically locked operation •Low profile selection switch •10A output contacts •LED status indication •Industry standard base connection Approvals: Auxiliary Products: Operation Alternating: When the rotary switch is in the “alternate” position, alternating operation of Load A and Load B occurs upon the opening of the control switch S1. To terminate alternating operation and cause only the selected load to operate, rotate the switch to position “A” to lock Load A or position “B” to lock Load B. The LEDs indicate the status of the internal relay and which load is selected to operate. Note: Input voltage must be applied at all times for proper alternation. The use of a solid-state control switch for S1 may not initiate alternation correctly. S1 voltage must be from the same supply as the unit’s input voltage (see connection diagrams). Loss of input voltage resets the unit; Load A becomes the lead load for the next operation. Duplexing (Cross Wired): Duplexing models operate the same as alternating relays and when both the Control (S1) and Lag Load (S2) Switches are closed, Load A and Load B energize simultaneously. The DPDT 8-pin, cross-wired option, allows extra system load capacity through simultaneous operation of both motors when needed. Relay contacts are not isolated. • Hold-down clips (sold in pairs): P/N: PSC8 (NDS-8) P/N: PSC11 (NDS-11) • Panel mount kit: P/N: BZ1 • 11-pin socket: P/N: NDS-11 • 8-pin socket: P/N: NDS-8 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM Available Models: ARP23S ARP41 ARP41S ARP42S ARP43 ARP43S ARP61S ARP63 ARP63S If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: ARP X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Output Form ─1 ─ - SPDT, 8-pin ─2 ─ - DPDT, 11-pin ─3 ─ - DPDT, 8-pin cross wired X Switch Operation ─Blank ─ - No Switch ─S ─ - Rotary Switch Specifications Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 24VAC. . . . . . 120 & 230VAC. . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC -15% - 20% -20% - 10% 50/60Hz Electromechanical relay SPDT, DPDT, or cross wired DPDT 10A resistive @ 120/240VAC & 28 VDC; 1/3 hp @ 120/240VAC Maximum Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250VAC Life. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical - 1 x 107; Electrical - 1 x 106 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Isolation Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 1500V RMS input to output Plug-in socket 3.2 x 2.39 x 1.78 in. (81.3 x 60.7 x 45.2 mm) Octal 8-pin or magnal 11-pin -20° to 60°C / -30° to 85°C ≅ 5.6 oz (159 g) NOTE: Unit does not have debounce time delay. 135 Series Included Tower & Obstruction Lighting Controls 136 Beacon Flasher FA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 FS155-. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 FS165-. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 Lamp Monitors Incandescent Lamps FB. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCR490D. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCR430T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCR630T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED Lamps FB9L. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCR9L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 139 140 140 141 142 Photo Controls PCR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Beacon Tower Flasher FS & FA Series B-KON Flashers have proven their reliability through years of use on communication towers, smoke stacks, cooling towers, tall buildings, bridges and utility towers. The highest quality components are encapsulated in a rugged plastic housing with a molded-in heat transfer plate. The flash rate, ratio, and fail-safe design meet FAA regulations. Zero voltage switching can increase lamp life up to ten times. The FS155-30RF & FS165-30RF include superior RF filtering circuitry for use in high RF installations; including AM hot towers. Features: For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 171, Figure 30 for connection diagram. Auxiliary Products: Operation FS Series - Flasher (OFF First) FA Series - Flashers & Aux. Modules Upon application of input voltage, the T2 OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the T1 ON time begins and the load energizes. At the end of T1, T2 begins and the load de-energizes. This cycle repeats until voltage is removed. Reset: Removing input voltage resets the output and the sequence to T2. •Zero voltage switching - up to 10 times longer lamp life •No RFI caused by contacts closing •High inrush capability - up to 200A •RF model for AM hot towers & other high RF installations •Auxiliary units for synchronous flashing or constant line loading Approvals: (FS155 & FA155 models only) • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: FA155 FA155-2 FA165 FA165-2 FS155-30RF FS155-30T FS165-30T If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: Input 120VAC 120VAC 230VAC 230VAC 120VAC 120VAC 230VAC 120VAC 230VAC Wattage 2500W 2500W 5000W 5000W 2500W 3000W 5000W 2500W 5000W Inrush 200A 200A 200A 200A 200A 300A 200A 200A 200A Description For High RF Radiation locations including AM Hot Towers Standard Flasher For High RF Radiation locations including AM Hot Towers Standard Flasher Auxiliary unit for synchronous operating of additional beacons Auxiliary unit with optical isolation between input and load contacts Auxiliary unit for sychronous operating of additional beacons Auxiliary unit to provide constant line loading Auxiliary unit to provide constant line loading Part Number FS155-30RF FS155-30T FS165-30RF FS165-30T FA155-2 FA155-3 FA165-2 FA155 FA165 Specifications Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single & multiple beacon flashing with auxiliary modules Flash Rate (FS Series Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 ±10 FPM ON/OFF Ratio (FS Series Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 - 67% ON time; 33 - 50% OFF time Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 or 230VAC ±20% AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output Rating (Zero Voltage Switching) . . . . . . . . 2500W @ 120VAC; 5000W @ 230VAC Inrush Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200A peak for 1 cycle of AC line Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . -55° to 65°C / -55° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) * Note: Must be mounted to metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 137 Flasher & Incandescent Beacon Alarm Relay The FB120A and FB230A are used to monitor the operation of one two-lamp incandescent beacon and one beacon flasher (or auxiliary module). The flasher and lamps are monitored by sensing the flow of current in the circuit. If the lamp(s) or the flasher fail to operate properly, a solid-state output and an isolated SPDT relay energize. When connected to a site monitoring system, this unit provides the remote beacon monitoring protection required by the FAA/FCC. On a multiple beacon structure, one unit is required for each two-lamp incandescent beacon (one unit per beacon for LED beacons). For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 32 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 171, Figure 31 for connection diagram. FB120A/FB230A Features: •Senses failed flashing incandescent beacon lamps & beacon flashers •Toroidal current sensing •One isolated, 5A, SPDT alarm output •Two 1A, solid-state line voltage alarm outputs •Trip delays prevent nuisance alarms Available Models: FB120A FB230A Operation If one lamp in an incandescent beacon fails, the relay and solid-state lamp failure outputs energize after 10s. If the flasher fails in the ON or OFF condition, the relay and the solid-state flasher failure output energizes after 6s. If both failures occur, all three outputs energize after their trip delays. Note: If both incandescent lamps fail, all three outputs will energize. The relay and solid-state flasher failure output energizes after 6s, and the solid-state lamp failure output energizes after 10s. Order Table: Input 120VAC 230VAC Lamp Type Incandescent Beacon Incandescent Beacon Part Number FB120A FB230A Specifications Input Voltage FB120A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FB230A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lamp Socket Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Alarm Outputs Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120VAC ±15% 230VAC ±15% 50/60Hz ±10%; 50/60Hz 3 total - 1 relay, 2 solid state; One isolated SPDT relay rated 5A resistive Two solid-state line voltage outputs rated 0.5A steady, 5A inrush Lamp Failure Detection FB120A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . For two 620W or 700W lamps FB230A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . For two 500W or 700W lamps Trip Delays Flasher Failure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed at 6s; -0/+40% 138 Lamp Failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LEDs Lamp Failure (Red). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flasher Failure (Red). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed at 10s; -0/+40% Glows when one or both lamps fail Glows when the flasher fails Encapsulated Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.75 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 44.5 mm) 7 position barrier block for 20 AWG (0.5 mm2) to 14 AWG (2.5 mm2) wire Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . -55° to 60°C / -55° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 7 oz (198 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Obstruction Lamp Alarm Relay SCR490D The SCR490D Series is used to provide remote monitoring of steady burning incandescent marker and obstruction lighting. Four onboard switches allow operator programming for lighting systems with two through nine lamps on a single AC circuit. The SCR490D uses a toroidal sensor and electronic circuitry to sense the failure of one or more lamps. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 32 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 171, Figure 32 for connection diagram. Operation When a lamp fails, the SCR490D senses a decrease in current flow. Then, after a fixed time delay, it transfers to its alarm mode. In alarm mode, the LED indicator, the output relay (SPDT isolated contacts), and a non-isolated solid-state output are energized. Replacement of the failed lamps resets the alarm outputs and the LED indicator. To prevent false alarm signals, power must be applied to the SCR490D at the same time that lamps are energized. Features: •Senses failed obstruction lamps •2 - 9 steadily burning lamps can be monitored •Toroidal current sensing •Isolated, 10A, SPDT alarm output contacts •1A, solid-state line voltage alarm output •6 second trip delay prevents nuisance alarms Approvals: Available Models: SCR490D Order Table: Input 120VAC Part Number SCR490D Specifications Operation Number of Lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lamp Wattage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rated Lamp Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitored Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance 120VAC. . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9 (selectable) 116W, incandescent lamps 120 or 130VAC (selectable) 120VAC ±3% ≅ 6s fixed 120VAC 50/60Hz - 20% - 10% Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.75 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 44.5 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screws with captive clamps for up to 14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wire Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Operating/Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . -55° to 65°C / -55° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6.8 oz (193 g) Line Voltage Output (Solid State Rated) . . . . . ≤ 125W to operate a spare lamp or alarm Isolated Alarm Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A @ 120VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 139 Universal Lamp Alarm Relay SCR Series The SCR series is a universal lamp alarm relay designed to sense the failure of flashing or steady incandescent beacon lamps or steady side lights. The toroidal current sensor provides isolation and allows monitoring of more than one line at a time. The SCR Series energizes when one or more lamps fail. It will monitor the operation of one to four side lights and up to four beacon lamps. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 32 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 171, Figure 33 for connection diagram. Operation When a lamp fails, the SCR Series senses a decrease in current flow. After a fixed time delay, the LED glows and the two alarm outputs energize. The outputs and the LED are reset when the failed lamps are replaced and the current returns to the nominal setting, or when the input voltage is removed. The SCR will sense an open flasher, it will not sense a continuously ON flasher (see FB Series). Order Table: Input 120VAC 230VAC Lamp Type Incandescent Incandescent Features: •Monitors incandescent lamps for failure •Senses failed flashing beacon or obstruction lamps •Switch selectable number, voltage, & wattage of lamps •Isolated, 10A, SPDT alarm output contacts •1A, solid-state line voltage alarm output •Toroidal current sensing Approvals: (SCR430T only) Available Models: SCR430T SCR630T Part Number SCR430T SCR630T Specifications Lamp Monitoring Capacity (in lamps). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCR430T 120VAC Lamps. . . . . . SCR630T 230VAC Lamps. . . . . . Time Delay Trip Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Input Voltage/Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100W 116W 620W 4 4 4 n/a 4 n/a 700W n/a 4 Factory fixed ≅ 6s SCR430T - 120VAC ±10% SCR630T - 230VAC ±10% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . To operate a spare lamp or alarm Line Voltage Output (Solid-state Rated). . . . . . . .≤ 125W @ 120VAC ≤ 250W @ 240VAC Isolated Alarm Output (SPDT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A @ 240VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC 140 Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two #6 (M3.5 x 0.6) screws Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 x 2.5 x 1.75 in. (88.9 x 63.5 x 44.5 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screws with captive clamps for up to 14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wire Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Environmental Operating Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .-55° to 65°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 6.8 oz (193 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Universal Lamp Alarm Relay FB9L The FB series is a universal lamp alarm relay designed to sense the failure of flashing LED beacon lamps. It will monitor the operation of one to eight beacons connected to a single flasher and/or auxiliary modules and the operation of the flasher. The FB Series output relay energizes when one or more lamps fail. All monitored lamps must be the same wattage and voltage. The 0.5A solid-state output energizes when a flasher failure is sensed. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 32 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 171, Figure 31 for connection diagram. Features: •Senses failed flashing beacon lamps •Switch selectable number of beacons •Senses flasher failure •Isolated, 10A, SPDT alarm output contacts •10A, NO line voltage alarm output •0.5A, solid-state flasher failure output “F” •Self calibrating; no fine adjustment required •Meets FAA-AC No: 150/5345-43E Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • DIN mount adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 • DIN rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Operation When a LED beacon lamp fails, the FB senses a decrease in current flow. After a 10s lamp failure trip delay, the isolated SPDT (4-5-6) and non-isolated SPNO (3-1) relay contacts energize. These contacts are used to indicate a Available Models: beacon failure has occurred. The “L” onboard LED indicator flashes green during the trip delay and glows red after the output relay energizes. Connected to a site monitoring system, it provides remote beacon monitoring FB9L required by FAA-AC No: 150/5345-43E. The FB also monitors the operation of the flasher. If the flasher remains in the ON or OFF condition for more than 6s the solid-state output energizes and the “F“ flasher failure, onboard LED glows red. This output is normally used to energize an external flasher bypass relay. The contacts of the bypass relay are used to route voltage around the failed flasher and to indicate an alarm condition. Note: In a single flasher, single beacon system, if the beacon lamp fails, zero current flow is detected. This will cause the flasher failure output to energize after 6s and then the beacon failure outputs after 10s. This is normal operation and can be expected anytime zero current is flowing through the monitored conductor. Calibration The alarm relays must be calibrated after initial installation and each time the LED lamps are replaced. In order to calibrate or re-calibrate the alarm relay, the internal memory must be cleared. Clearing Memory: Remove input voltage, transfer the calibration switch to the off position, re-apply input voltage. The LED will flash Red to indicate the memory is clear and the relay is ready for calibration. Calibration: 1) Perform visual inspection of the structure’s lighting to assure all lamps and flashers are operating properly. 2) Remove input voltage, and check to ensure the calibrate switch is in the OFF position. Adjust the lamp selector switches for the correct number of similar (see note a) lamps to be monitored. 3) Reapply input voltage, the LED should flash Red. After confirming the LED is flashing Red and the lamp selector switches are properly adjusted, transfer the calibrate switch from OFF to ON. The LED will alternately flash Red & Green. Within 30 seconds the LED will glow Green indicating input power is applied and the unit is calibrated. Leave the calibrate switch in the ON position. Reapplying input voltage when this switch is in the ON position does not affect the calibration settings. Calibration Failed: 4) If the relay is unable to establish trip points for the setup conditions within 60 seconds, the LED will double blink Red. Remove input voltage and repeat steps 2 and 3. Notes: a. Monitoring a mixture of LED beacons and LED obstruction lamps is not possible with the SCR9L. b. This alarm relay is not designed to monitor incandescent lamps. c. This alarm relay must be recalibrated each time an LED lamp is replaced. d. Due to LED lamp aging, recalibration every 12 months is recommended. e. Applying input voltage when the calibrate switch is in the OFF position, erases the previous calibration settings. The LED will flash Red. The output relays are OFF and the unit will not sense lamp failures. f. Only one (1) temperature compensated LED Beacon can be monitored with this product. A combination of temperature compensated and standard LED Beacons cannot be monitored. Indicator Table: Order Table: Input 120 - 230VAC Beacon Type Part Number LED FB9L L Green Input ON & Calibrated L Green Flashing Trip Delay L Red Lamp Failure L Red/Green Flashing Calibrating L Red Flashing Not Calibrated F Red Flasher Failure Specifications Sensors Calibration Range (total all Lamps). . . . . . . . . Absolute Max Current (total all Lamps). . . . . Single Lamp Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip Delay Flasher Failure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lamp Failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Input Voltage/Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Line Voltage Output (SPNO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150mA - 8.0A 15A max. (may not calibrate above 8A) 150mA - 8.0A (total all lamps < 8.0A) Fixed at 6s; -0/+40% Fixed at 10s; -0/+40% 120 to 230VAC / ±15% 50/60Hz To operate a spare lamp or alarm 5A @ 240VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC Isolated Alarm Output (SPDT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A @ 240VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Solid-state Line Voltage Output (F). . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LEDs Power/Timing/Lamp Failure (Bi color) . . . . . Flasher Failure (Red). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5A steady; 5A inrush One #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 3 x 2 x 1.64 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 41.7 mm) IP20 screw terminals for up to 14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wire or two 16 AWG (1.3 mm2) wires Glows red when one or more lamps fail Glows red when the flasher fails Encapsulated -40° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) 141 Universal Lamp Alarm Relay SCR9L The SCR series is a universal lamp alarm relay designed to sense the failure of flashing or steady LED beacon lamps or obstruction lamps. The SCR Series energizes when one or more lamps fail. It will monitor the operation of one to eight beacon or obstruction lamps. All monitored lamps must be the same wattage and voltage When connected to a site monitoring system, it provides the remote lamp monitoring protection required by the FAAAC No: 150/5345-43E. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 32 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 35 for connection diagram. Features: •Monitors LED lamps for failure •Senses failed flashing or steady beacon or obstruction lamps •Switch selectable number of lamps •Isolated, 10A, SPDT alarm output contacts •5A, NO line voltage alarm output •Self calibrating; no fine adjustment required •Meets FA-AC No: 150/5345-43E Approvals: Available Models: SCR9L Operation When a lamp fails, the SCR Series senses a decrease in current flow. After a 10s trip delay, the onboard LED glows and the two alarm outputs energize. The outputs and the LED are reset when the failed lamps are replaced and the unit is recalibrated. The SCR will sense an open flasher, it will not sense a continuously ON flasher (see FB Series). Removing input voltage de-energizes the output and the LED‘s. It does not change the calibration. Calibration The alarm relays must be calibrated after initial installation and each time the LED lamps are replaced. In order to calibrate or re-calibrate the alarm relay, the internal memory must be cleared. Clearing Memory: Remove input voltage, transfer the calibration switch to the off position, re-apply input voltage. The LED will flash Red to indicate the memory is clear and the relay is ready for calibration. Calibration: 1) Perform visual inspection of the structure’s lighting to assure all lamps and flashers (if used) are operating properly. 2) Remove input voltage, and check to ensure the calibrate switch is in the OFF position. Adjust the lamp selector switches for the correct number of similar (see note a) lamps to be monitored. 3) Reapply input voltage, the LED should flash Red. After confirming the LED is flashing Red and the lamp selector switches are properly adjusted, transfer the calibrate switch from OFF to ON. The LED will alternately flash Red & Green. Within 30 seconds the LED will glow Green indicating input power is applied and the unit is calibrated. Leave the calibrate switch in the ON position. Reapplying input voltage when this switch is in the ON position does not affect the calibration settings. Calibration Failed: 4) If the relay is unable to establish trip points for the setup conditions within 60 seconds, the LED will double blink Red. Remove input voltage and repeat steps 2 and 3. Notes: a. Monitoring a mixture of LED beacons and LED obstruction lamps is not possible with the SCR9L. b. This alarm relay is not designed to monitor incandescent lamps. c. This alarm relay must be recalibrated each time an LED lamp is replaced. d. Due to LED lamp aging, recalibration every 12 months is recommended. e. Applying input voltage when the calibrate switch is in the OFF position, erases the previous calibration settings. The LED will flash Red. The output relays are OFF and the unit will not sense lamp failures. f. Only one temperature compensated LED Beacon can be monitored with this product. A combination of temperature compensated and standard LED Beacons cannot be monitored. Indicator Table: Order Table: Input 120 - 230VAC Lamp Type LED Part Number SCR9L L Green Input ON & Calibrated L Green Flashing Trip Delay L Red Lamp Failure L Red/Green Flashing Calibrating L Red Flashing Not Calibrated Specifications Sensors Calibration Range (total all Lamps). . . . . . . Absolute Max Current (total all Lamps). . . Single Lamp Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Delay Trip Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Input Voltage/Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Line Voltage Output (SPNO). . . . . . . . . . . . . 150mA - 8.0A 15A max. (may not calibrate above 8A) 150mA - 8.0A (total all lamps < 8.0A) Factory fixed ≅10s 120 to 230VAC ±15% 50/60Hz To operate a spare lamp or alarm 5A @ 240VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC Isolated Alarm Output (SPDT). . . . . . . . . . . 10A @ 240VAC or 30VDC resistive; 1/4 hp @ 125VAC; 1/2 hp @ 250VAC 142 Auxilliary Input Voltage (H). . . . . . . . . . . . . < 2A @ 230VAC Mechanical Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . One #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 x 2 x 1.64 in (76.7 x 51.3 x 41.7 mm) Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IP20 screw terminals for up to 14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wire or two 16 AWG (1.3 mm2) wires Protection Circuitry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / - 40° to 85°C Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Photo Control PCR Series The PCR Series of photo control is a combination of precision electronic circuitry, electromechanical output, and unique molded plastic housing. Designed and built to meet the demands of the most rigorous requirement of tower and obstruction lighting control, each unit is factory calibrated to meet FAA and FCC specifications. Electronic circuit, output contactor, and terminal block are all contained within front plastic housing. Edge support molded into the bottom edge of housing allows easy wiring of new and existing installations. Available with or without cast aluminum junction box. For more information see: Appendix B, page 167, Figure 33 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 36 for connection diagram. Features: •Automatic lighting circuit operation: dusk to dawn •Meets FAA/FCC requirements for obstruction lighting •Two 20A load contacts •Direct replacement of popular photo controls •Time delay eliminates contact chatter Available Models: PCR10 PCR11 PCR12 PCR13 Operation When the amount of light sensed falls below the actuation level for energization, the output relay energizes. Conversely, when the amount rises above the actuation level for de-energization, the output relay de-energizes. Conversion Chart Order Table: Input 120VAC 230VAC 120VAC 230VAC REPLACES Description Photo Control without aluminum box Photo Control without aluminum box Photo Control with aluminum box Photo Control with aluminum box Part Number PCR10 PCR12 PCR11 PCR13 Part Number Hughey & Phillips PCR11 PC800 120V PEC52010 PCR13 PC800 240V PEC52010-1 Crouse Hinds Specifications Indication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED indicates power is applied Light Actuation Levels (Factory Calibrated). . . . . . Energized: ≥ 35 fc De-energized: ≤ 60 fc Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120VAC or 230VAC AC Line Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Tolerance 120 & 230VAC . . . . . . . . -20% - 10% Output Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Two SPST NO 20A contacts 1 hp @ 120VAC 2.5 hp @ 240VAC Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screw terminals for up to #8 (M4 x 0.7) AWG wire Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ABS plastic housing with gasket seal. Multiple knockout holes for optional mounting to Crouse Hinds or Hughey & Phillips cast aluminum electrical boxes. Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . -40° to 60°C / -55° to 85°C www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 143 Series Included Solid-State Relays SIR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 SLR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 NLF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 PHS Series PHS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Solid-State Relays 144 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Solid-State Relay - Isolated SIR1 & SIR2 Series Designed for industrial applications requiring rugged reliable operation. Provides an optically isolated, high capacity, solid-state output, with power switching capability up to 20A steady state, 200A inrush. Zero voltage switching SIR2 extends the life of an incandescent lamp up to 10 times. Random switching SIR1 is ideal for inductive loads. When fully insulated female terminals are used on the connection wires, the system meets the requirements for touch-proof connections. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 37 for connection diagram. Operation The solid-state output is located between terminals 1 and 3, and is normally open or normally closed without control voltage applied to terminals 4 and 5. When control voltage is applied to terminals 4 and 5, the solid-state output opens or closes respectively. Reset: Removing control voltage resets the output. The unit is also reset if output voltage is removed. Function: Features: •SIR1 - Random switching for inductive loads •SIR2 - Zero voltage switching for resistive & incandescent loads •Normally open or normally closed output •3 - 20A with up to 200A inrush •Encapsulated circuitry •Optically isolated output •0.25 in. (6.35 mm) terminals with single hole mounting Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: SIR1A10A6 SIR1A6A2 SIR1B10A4 SIR1B10B4 SIR1B20A4 V = Voltage CV = Control Voltage R = Reset NC = Normally Closed Output NO = Normally Open Output SIR1B6B4 SIR1C20B6 SIR2A20A4 SIR2B20A4 SIR2B20B4 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. = Undefined time Order Table: X Series ─SIR1 ─ - Random Switching ─SIR2 ─ - Zero Voltage Switching X Control Voltage ─A ─ - 9 - 30VAC or DC ─B ─ - 90 - 150VAC or DC ─C ─ - 190 - 290VAC or DC X Rating ─1 ─ - 3A ─6 ─ - 6A ─10 ─ - 10A ─20 ─ - 20A Solid-state Output Contact X X Form Voltage ─A ─ - Normally Open ─B ─ - Normally Closed ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC Specifications Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Optical isolation, totally solid state SPST, NO or NC 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% Steady State Inrush* Output Device 3A 30A Triac 6A 60A Triac 10A 100A Triac 20A 200A Triac Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 50mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.0V at rated current Leakage Current (Open State). . . . . . . . ≅ 6mA Input Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Optical isolation LED/photo transistor Control Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 to 290VAC/DC in 3 ranges Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 0.5W www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100 MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -40° to 60°C / -55° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) *Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 145 Solid-State Relay - Non-Isolated SLR Series The SLR Series has no isolation between the control switch input and the solid-state output. Select the SLR for applications where the control switch is the same voltage source as the load. Provides the noiseless, reliability and long life of a solid-state relay, without the cost of isolation circuitry. Zero voltage switching SLR2 can extend the life of an incandescent lamp up to 10 times its normal life. Random switching SLR1 is normally used for inductive loads. When fully insulated female terminals are used on the connection wires, the system meets the requirements for touch-proof connections. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 38 for connection diagram. Function: Operation The solid-state output is located between terminals 1 and 2 and can be ordered as either normally open or normally closed, when voltage is applied and S1 is open. When S1 is closed, the solid-state output between terminals 1 and 2 closes (or opens). If S1 is opened, the solid-state output will open (or close). Reset: Opening S1 resets the output to its original state. Reset is also accomplished by removing input voltage. V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch R = Reset NO = Normally Open Output NC = Normally Closed Output Features: •SLR1 - Random switching for inductive loads •SLR2 - Zero voltage switching for resistive & incandescent loads •Normally open or normally closed output •1 - 20A with up to 200A inrush •0.25 in. (6.35 mm) termination with single hole mounting •Noiseless switching, reliability, and long life Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: SLR1410B SLR1420A SLR1610A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. = Undefined time Order Table: X Series ─SLR1 ─ - Random Switching ─SLR2 ─ - Zero Voltage Switching X Voltage ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Output Rating ─1 ─ - 1A ─6 ─ - 6A ─10 ─ - 10A ─20 ─ - 20A X Output Form ─A ─ - Normally Open ─B ─ - Normally Closed Specifications Output (Contact) Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voltage Drop (at Rated Current). . . . . . . Leakage Current (Open State). . . . . . . . . Initiate Switch Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Protection Non-isolated solid state Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated SPST, NO or NC Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface 24, 120, or 230VAC Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 100MΩ ±20% Mechanical Steady State Inrush* Output Device Mounting*. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 1A 10A SCR & Bridge Rectifier Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 6A 60A Triac Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals 10A 100A Triac Environmental 20A 200A Triac Operating / Storage Temperature . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C ≅ 50mA Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing ≅ 2.0V - 6, 10, & 20A units; ≅ 2.5V - 1A units Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A units: ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g); ≤ 5mA 6, 10, 20A units: ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) Same as the output voltage *Must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The ≤ 0.5W maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Impulse Latching Relay NLF1/NLF2 Series The NLF1 and NLF2 Series provide a flip-flop latching function. Each time the control switch is closed, the solid-state output changes state and latches. The NLF Series has no isolation between the control switch and the solid-state output, which lowers cost and reduces the number of connections required. For use where the control switch is the same voltage source as the load. Zero voltage switching NLF2 extends the life of an incandescent lamp by up to 10 times. Random switching NLF1 is ideal for inductive loads. When accessory fully insulated female terminals are used on the connection wires, the system meets the requirements for touch-proof connections. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 39 for connection diagram. Function: Operation The solid-state output is located between terminals 1 and 2, and can be ordered as either normally open or normally closed, when voltage is applied. When S1 is closed, the solid-state output between terminals 1 and 2 closes (or opens). If S1 is opened and reclosed, the solid-state output will open (or close). Reset: Open and reclose S1. Reset is also accomplished by removing and reapplying input voltage. V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch R = Reset NO = Normally Open Output NC = Normally Closed Output Features: •Totally solid-state latching relay encapsulated •Non-isolated to reduce cost •1 - 20A with 200A inrush •24, 120, or 230VAC input voltages •NLF1 - Random switching for inductive loads •NLF2 - Zero voltage switching for lamp & resistive loads Auxiliary Products: • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) Available Models: NLF126A NLF141A NLF1620A If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. = Undefined time Order Table: X Series ─NLF1 ─ - Random Switching ─NLF2 ─ - Zero Voltage Switching X Input ─2 ─ - 24VAC ─4 ─ - 120VAC ─6 ─ - 230VAC X Output Rating ─1 ─ - 1A ─6 ─ - 6A ─10 ─ - 10A ─20 ─ - 20A X Output Form ─A ─ - Normally Open ─B ─ - Normally Closed Specifications Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated solid state Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPST, NO or NC Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Steady State Inrush* Output Device 1A 10A SCR & Bridge Rectifier 6A 60A Triac 10A 100A Triac 20A 200A Triac Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . 50mA Voltage Drop (at Rated Current). . . . . . ≅ 2.0V – 6, 10, & 20A units; ≅ 2.5V – 1A units Leakage Current (Open State). . . . . . . . ≤ 5mA Input Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Non-isolated, switch contact (customer supplied) Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 120, or 230VAC ±20% Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 0.5W Operations Per Second. . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≤ 5 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Protection Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dielectric Breakdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Mounting *. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensions 6, 10, 20A units . . . . . . . 1A units . . . . . . . Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Encapsulated ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface ≥ 100MΩ Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing 1A units: ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g); 6, 10, 20A units: ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) *Units rated ≥ 6A must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. 147 Phase Control PHS Series The PHS Series is an ideal method of changing lamp intensity, varying the speed of a fan/ motor, or controlling the temperature of a heater. The effective output voltage is adjusted with an accessory external potentiometer suitable for line voltage applications. For more information see: Appendix B, page 165, Figure 4 for dimensional drawing. Appendix C, page 172, Figure 40 for connection diagram. Operation Upon application of input voltage, effective output voltage can be varied by changing the external resistance value. As the external resistance increases, the effective output voltage decreases. The inverse is also true. Typical Output Waveform Features: •External adjustment - 230VAC rated potentiometer •120 or 230VAC input voltages available •Up to 20A steady state - 200A inrush •Single hole surface mounting Approvals: Auxiliary Products: • Versa-knob: P/N: P0700-7 • Quick connect to screw adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 • Female quick connect: P/N: P1015-13 (AWG 10/12) P/N: P1015-64 (AWG 14/16) P/N: P1015-14 (AWG 18/22) • Potentiometers: P/N: P1004-174 (100kΩ 1W) P/N: P1004-175 (200kΩ 2W) Available Models: PHS120A10 PHS120A20 PHS120A6 PHS230A1 PHS230A10 PHS230A20 PHS230A6 If desired part number is not listed, please call us to see if it is technically possible to build. Order Table: PHS X Input Voltage ─120A ─ - 120VAC ─230A ─ - 230VAC X Rating ─—1 ─ - 1A ──6 ─ - 6A ─10 ─ - 10A ─20 ─ - 20A Specifications Output Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable voltage phase angle control Rating Steady State (at 100% On) Inrush* 1A 10A 6A 60A 10A 100A 20A 200A Minimum Load Current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100mA Voltage Drop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≅ 2.0V at rated current Input Voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 or 230VAC Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ±20% AC Line Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50/60Hz Protection Dielectric Breakdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥ 2000V RMS terminals to mounting surface Insulation Resistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ≥100MΩ 148 Mechanical Mounting *. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) screw Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 x 2 x 1.51 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 38.4 mm) Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals Environmental Operating / Storage Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . -20° to 60°C / -40° to 85°C Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95% relative, non-condensing Weight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A: ≅ 2.4 oz (68 g) 6, 10, & 20A: ≅ 3.9 oz (111 g) External Adjustment Potentiometer 120VAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100KΩ rated at 1W 230VAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200KΩ rated at 2W Must have insulation resistance suitable for line voltage applications. *Units rated ≥ 6A must be bolted to a metal surface using the included heat sink compound. The maximum mounting surface temperature is 90°C. Inrush: Non-repetitive for 16ms. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Series Included DIN Rail/Surface Mount Sockets Sockets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 DIN Rail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Hold-Down Clips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Hold-Down Brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Mounting Methods, Terminals, Varistors, Cover and Marker 151 150 151 151 151 151 151 Timer Adjustment Options & Dials Versa Pot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Versa Knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lock Shaft. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini Pot. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini Knob. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Time Adjustment Dials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VTP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 152 152 152 152 153 153 Motor Protectors Three-Phase Fuse Block/Disconnect. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Voltage Reduction Module. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Accessories Mini Mount/Standard Bracket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front Panel Mount Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DIN Rail Mount Adaptor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Heat Sink Compound. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quick Connect Screw Adaptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Female Quick Connect Terminals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Metal Oxide Varistors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Liquid Level Probes & Probe Holders Liquid Level Control Electrodes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Liquid Level Probe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 149 Accessories Octal Sockets: 8-pin P/N: OT08PC 8-pin 35mm DIN rail or surface mount octal socket. OT08PC is rated at 10A @ 600VAC and has pressure clamp terminals. For use with AWG 12 to 22 (3.2 to 0.33 mm2) wire sizes. P/N: NDS-8 8-pin 35mm DIN rail or surface mount octal socket. NDS-8 is rated at 10A @ 300VAC. Surface mounted with two #6 (M 3.5 x 0.6) screws or snaps onto a 35 mm DIN rail. A spring mechanism allows easy removal. Screw terminals with captive wire clamps accept up to two #14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wires. Uses PSC8 hold-down clips. P/N: P1011-6 8-pin surface mount socket with binder head screw terminals. Rated 10A @ 600VAC. When used with TDM, TDB, TDS Series timers the combination is UL Listed. Uses PSCRB8 hold-down brackets. Magnal Sockets: 11-pin P/N: OT11PC 11 pin 35 mm DIN rail or surface mount socket. OT11PC is rated at 10A @ 300VAC and has pressure clamp terminals. For use with AWG 12 to 22 (3.2 to 0.33 mm2) wire sizes. P/N: NDS-11 11 pin 35 mm DIN rail or surface mount socket. OT11PC is rated at 10A @ 300VAC. Surface mounted with two #6 (M 3.5 x 0.6) screws or snaps onto a 35 mm DIN rail. A spring mechanism allows easy removal. Screw terminals with captive wire clamps accept up to two #14 AWG (2.45 mm2) wires. Uses PSC11 hold-down clips. Hold-down Clips: P/N: PSC8 or PSC11 Securely mounts plug in controls in any position. Also provides protection against vibration. Select the PSC8 for use with NDS-8, or the PSC11 for use with NDS-11 sockets. Comes in sets of two. Hold-down Brackets: P/N: PSCRB8 Designed for use with P1011-6 socket. Securely mounts 8-pin plug-in controls in any position, and provides protection against vibration. Sold in pairs. Front Panel Mount Kit: PANEL OPENING 2.6 +/-.02 (66.0 +/-.5) P/N: BZ1 Provides an easy method of through-the-panel mounting of 8 or 11-pin plug-in timers, flashers, and other controls. May be mounted in panels up to 0.125 in. (3.2 mm) thick. Includes two clamps and two screws. 1.9 +/-.02 (48.3 +/-.5) Inches (Millimeters) Illustrates panel opening size required to mount BZ1. 150 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Accessories Mount Brackets: 0.56 (14.3) 0.19 (4.8) 1.5 (38.1) 0.47 (11.9) d 1.25 (31.8) 2.1 (53.3) D = 0.25(6.35) (P1023-7) Inches (Millimeters) D = 0.19(4.8) (P1023-6) P/N: P1023-6 / P1023-7 Provides a convenient method of mounting 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) or 2 x 3 x 1.5 in. (50.8 x 76.2 x 38.1 mm) modules. The 90° orientation of mounting slots makes installation/removal of modules quick and easy. The P1023-6 secures to module with a #8 (M4 x 0.7) screw. The P1023-7 secures to 2 x 2 x 1.21 in. (50.8 x 50.8 x 30.7 mm) module with Mini-Pot for local adjustment. Made from steel with a cadmium surface finish. Mounting Method #8 (M4 x 0.7) screw Mini-Pot Mounting Hole Size 0.19 in. (4.8 mm) 0.25 in (6.35 mm) P/N P1023-6 P1023-7 DIN Rail: P/N: C103PM (Al) Industry standard 35 mm aluminum or steel DIN rail. C103PM aluminum rail is available in a 36 in. (91.4 cm) length. DIN Rail Mount Adaptor: P/N: P1023-20 Allows any 2 x 2 in. (50.8 x 50.8 mm) or 2 x 3 in. (50.8 x 76.2 mm) module to be mounted on a 35 mm DIN type rail. Comes complete with mounting hardware for 0.75 in. (19 mm) and 1 in. (25.4 mm) thick modules. Heat Sink Compound: P/N: P0200-19 Single package of heat sink compound sufficient to mount one high current, plated 2” x 2” (50.8 x 50.8 mm) timer or flasher. Contains approximately 2 grams. Quick Connect Screw Adaptor: P/N: P1015-18 Screw adaptor terminal designed for use with all modules with 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) male quick connect terminals. Screw terminal accepts ring or spade terminals. Part Number P1015-13 P1015-64 P1015-14 Wire Size AWG 10/12 (5.3/3.2 mm2) AWG 14/16 (2.5/1.3 mm2) AWG 18/22 (0.93/0.33 mm2) Female Quick Connect Terminals: These 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) female terminals are constructed with an insulator barrel to provide strain relief. Metal Oxide Varistor: P/N P1012-25 Max. Operating Voltage DC (V) AC (V) 200 150 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Max Impulse Current 80.20 us current wave (A) 4500 Varistor Voltage at 1mA DC Test Current Min. (V) Max. (V) 212 268 Peak Clamping Voltage with 80 us wave Vc (V) 1p (A) 395 50 Capacitance Size (mm) 800 14 151 Accessories Versa-Pot: Panel mountable, industrial potentiometer recommended for remote time delay adjustment. The shaft is slotted for screwdriver adjustment and serrated for slip-proof finger adjustment. Accepts Versa-Knob or Lock Shaft. May be ordered with two 8 in. (20.3 cm) wires soldered to pot (clockwise increase) and female quick connect terminals on other ends by adding suffix -X to end of part number. P/N With Wire Leads Value 25kΩ P1004-198 50kΩ P1004-199 P1004-95 P1004-95-X 100kΩ 500kΩ P1004-17 P1004-16 P1004-16-X 1MΩ 1.5MΩ P1004-15 P1004-12 P1004-12-X 3MΩ 5MΩ P1004-13 Specifications Rating Taper Shaft Rotation Tolerance 0.25W at 55°C Linear 300° ±5° ±10% Versa-Knob: P/N: 0700-7 Versa-Knob is designed for 0.25 in (6.35 mm) shaft of Versa-Pot. Semi-gloss industrial black finish. Lock Shaft: P/N: P0700-8 Fits 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) potentiometer shafts. Locks by tightening nut onto four tapered/slotted fingers. Pressure on the shaft locks control against misadjustment. Nickel plated brass finish. Mini-Pot: P/N: P1004-10 & P1004-31 A high quality, industrial potentiometer for remote time delay adjustment. The shaft extends through the timer’s center hole for easy panel mounting. Use mini-mount bracket for standup mounting of timer. Adjustment by screwdriver or mini-knob. May be ordered with two 3 in. (7.6 cm) wires soldered to pot (clockwise increase) and female quick connect terminals on other ends by adding suffix -X to end of part number. P/N With Wire Leads Value P1004-9 P1004-9-X 500kΩ P1004-10 P1004-10-X 1MΩ P1004-31 P1004-31-X 3MΩ Specifications Rating Taper Shaft Rotation Tolerance 0.25W at 55°C Linear 300° ±5° ±10% Mini-Knob: P/N: 0700-21 Black plastic control knob with fluted body and white index/dot for setting accuracy. Mounts on 0.125 in. (3.2 mm) shaft of Mini-Pot. 152 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Accessories Time Adjustment Dials: Dials for use with remote Versa-Pot and panel mounted Mini-Pot. Reverse screen printed on clear plastic to avoid damage to printed image. P/N Range P0400-82 P0400-17 P0400-83 P0400-27 Increments 0.1 - 10s 1 - 30s 1 - 60s 0 - 10 1s 5s 10s MRD* *Multiplier Reference Dial VTP: The VTP Series mounts on modules with in-line adjustment terminals. Rated at 0.25W at 55°C. Available in resistance values from 5 K Ω to 5M Ω. Ordering Table (select one from each column) Series RT Value Range VTPA – 5KΩ A –0.05 - 1s B – 10KΩ B – 0.05- 3s C – 20KΩ C – 0.1 -10s D – 50KΩ D – 0.5- 10s 0 – 250KΩ E – 0.5 - 20s 1 – 0.5MΩ F – 0.5 - 60s 2 –1MΩ G – 1 - 100s 3 – 2 MΩ H – 2 - 120s 4 – 3MΩ J – 2 - 180s 5 – 5 MΩ K – 10 - 1000s L – 0.1 - 4m M – 0.1 - 6m N – 0.1 - 10m P – 1 - 100m R – 0 - 10MRD* S – 0.1 - 8m T – 0.1 - 5m X – All time range labels Approvals: Available Models: VTP1B VTP1C VTP1D VTP2E VTP2F VTP2J VTP2P VTP3B VTP3L VTP4B VTP4F VTP4J VTP4P VTP5G VTP5K VTP5N VTPDF Three-Phase Fuse Block/Disconnect: P/N: FH3P 3-phase fuse block disconnect designed for use with HRC midget fuses [1.5 x .41 in. (38.1 x 10.4 mm)] rated up to 30A @ 600VAC. DIN3 rail mounting. 3.9 x 2.09 x 2.2 in. (99 x 53.1 x 55.9 mm) Replaced P/N: P0700-241 P/N: P0600-11 (Midget Fuse) Fast acting fuse for use with voltage monitors. Rated 2A @ 500VAC. 1.5 x .41 in. (38.1 x 10.4 mm) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 153 Accessories Voltage Monitor Accessory Module: P/N: VRM6048 The VRM6048 accessory module allows the voltage monitor to monitor a 3-phase 550 to 600VAC Line. The VRM can be used with voltage monitor series: TVM, TVW, PLM, PLR, and PLS manufactured after December 2003. 575VAC → 460VAC *The VRM6048 must be connected as shown. If the voltage monitor is disconnected, the VRM output voltage equals the input voltage. Adjustment: If the measured line voltage is 575VAC, connect as shown and adjust/select the voltage monitor for 460VAC operation. VRM Module Package: Voltage Monitor Mounting: Termination: Operating: Storage: Humidity: Voltage: Molded housing with encapsulated circuitry Surface mount with one #10 (M5 x 0.8) plastic screw. May be DIN Rail mounted using P1023-20 Adaptor. Screw terminals with captive wire clamps for up to No.12 AWG wire. -40° to 70°C -40° to 85°C 95% relative, non-condensing INPUT *OUTPUT 600VAC480VAC 575VAC460VAC 550VAC440VAC Liquid Level Control Electrodes: P/N: PHST-38QTN (Probe Holder) & P0700-409 (Protective Boot) Designed for use with all conductive liquid level controls. Composed of insulators and metal parts made of number 300 series stainless steel. These internally conductive probe holders are designed for a maximum steam pressure of 240 PSI; 400° F maximum. Maximum voltage from electrode to ground. PHST-38QTN is UL353 Recognized. Liquid Level Probe: P/N: LLP-24 Threaded stainless steel probe measuring 24 in. (61 cm) long. Designed for use with PHST-38QTN liquid level control electrodes. 154 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix A Timer Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 TRDU Function Diagrams. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Flasher Function Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Appendix B Dimensional Drawings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Appendix C Appendix Connection Diagrams. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 155 Appendix A - Timer Functions Selecting a Timer’s Function Selecting one of the five most common timing functions can be as easy as answering three questions on the chart below. If you have trouble answering these questions, try drawing a connection diagram that shows how the timer and load are connected. Time diagrams and written descriptions of the five most popular functions, plus other common functions. Instantaneous contacts, accumulation, pause timing functions, and flashing LED’s are included in some units to expand the versatility of the timer. These expanded operations are explained on the product’s catalog page. Time diagrams are used on these pages along with text and international symbols for functions. Function Selection Guide THE FIVE MOST USED FUNCTIONS Selection Questions 1) The timing starts when the initiate (starting) contacts are: A) Closed B) Opened 2) What is the status of the output (or load) during timing: A) On B) Off C) On/Off 3) Will the load de-energize (or remain de-energized) if the initiate (starting) contacts are opened during timing: A) Yes B) No Understanding Time Diagrams Time diagrams are used to show the relative operation of switches, controls, and loads as time progresses. Time begins at the first vertical boundary. There may be a line indicating the start of the operation or it may just begin with the transition of the device that starts the operation. Each row in the time diagram represents a separate component. These rows will be labeled with the name of the device or its terminal connection numbers. In a bistable or digital system, the switches, controls, or loads can only be ON or OFF. The time lines are drawn to represent these two possible conditions. Vertical lines are used to define important starting or ending points in the operation. The example to the right is the most common type of time diagram in use in North America. It shows the energizing of loads, and the closing of switches and contacts by an ascending vertical transition of the time line. Opening switches or contacts or de-energizing loads are represented by descending vertical transitions. 156 TIME DIAGRAM Example: Delay-on-Break (Release) Input Initiate Switch Applied Off Closed Open Output Energized (Normally De-energized Open) R = Reset TD = Time Delay S1 = Initiate Switch Undefined time t = Incomplete Time Delay www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix A - Timer Functions INTERNATIONAL TIMING FUNCTION SYMBOLS = Delay-on-Make; ON-delay = Delay-on-Break; OFF-delay = Delay-on-Make & Break; ON and OFF-delay = Interval; Impulse-ON = Trailing Edge Interval; Impulse-OFF = Single Shot; Pulse Former = Flasher - ON Time First; Recycling Equal Times - ON First = Flasher - OFF Time First; Recycling Equal Times - OFF First = Recycling - Unequal Times; Pulse Generator = Recycling - Unequal Times Starting with ON or OFF = Delay-on-Make & Interval; Single Pulse Generator ® Delay-on-Make: (ProgramaCube Function M) Delay-on-Make (ON-delay) (ON-delay, Delay on Operate, On Delay, Operate Delay, Delay On, Prepurge Delay) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output (relay or solid state) is de-energized before and during the time delay. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until input voltage is removed. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TDM, TRDU Extra Functions Included in Some Delay-on-Make (DOM) Timers: Accumulating Delay-on-Make (Operate) ® Accumulating Time Delay Feature: (ProgramaCube Function AM) Some DOM timers allow the time delay to be stopped and held and then resumed by opening and closing an external switch. The total time delay, TD is the sum of the accumulated partial time delays, “t”. See: KRPD, KRPS, HRPS, NHPS, KSPD, KSPS, TRDU Instantaneous Contacts: Some DOM timers have a set of instantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Instantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. Delay-on-Make (Normally Closed) Delay-on-Make, Normally Closed Output: All relay output delay-on-make timers with normally closed contacts include this function. (See Delay-on-Make NC Contacts) This function is also available in solidstate output timers. The solid-state output energizes when input voltage is applied. The time delay begins when an optional initiate switch S1 is closed (timing starts when voltage is applied if S1 is not used). The output de-energizes at the end of the time delay. Reset: Opening S1 resets the time delay and the output immediately energizes (or remains energized). Removing input voltage resets the time delay and de-energizes the output. See: KSD4, THD4, TS4, TSD4 Interval (Impulse ON) ® Interval: (ProgramaCube Function I) (Impulse-ON, Single Pulse on Operate, On Interval, Interval On, Pulse Shaping, Bypass Timing) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, the time delay begins. The output (relay or solid state) energizes during the time delay. At the end of time delay the output de-energizes and remains de-energized until input voltage is removed. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TDI, TSD2 Extra Functions Included on Some Interval Timers: Instantaneous Contacts: Some Interval timers have a set of intantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Intantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. Legend V = Voltage NO = Normally Open Contact R = Reset NC = Normally Closed Contact TD = Time Delay t = Incomplete (Partial) Time Delay S1 = Initiate Switch L = Load = Undefined time www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 157 Appendix A - Timer Functions Timer Functions Popular Functions ® Recycling: (ProgramaCube Functions RE, RD, RXE, RXD) (Flasher, Pulse Generator, Recycle Timing, Repeat Cycle, Duty Cycling) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, the output (relay or solid state) energizes and the ON time begins. At the end of the ON time, the output de-energizes and the OFF time begins. At the end of the OFF time, the output energizes and the cycle repeats as long as input voltage is applied. The OFF time may be the first delay in some recycling timers. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. The time delays in some recycling timers are equal TD1=TD2. Flashers are an example of this type of recycling timer. Others have separately selectable time delays. See: HRPD, HRPS, KRPD, KRPS, KSPD, KSPS, KSPU, NHPD, NHPS, NHPU, TDR Recycling w/Reset Switch Extra Functions Included in Some Recycling Timers: Instantaneous Contacts: Some Recycling timers have a set of instantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Instantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. RESET SWITCH: Closing an external switch transfers the output and resets the sequence to the first delay. See: HRDR ® Delay-on-Break: (ProgramaCube Function B) Delay-on-Break (OFF-delay) (Delay on Release, OFF-delay, Release Delay, Postpurge Delay) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch, the output (relay or solid state) energizes. The time delay begins when the initiate switch is opened. The output remains energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The output will energize if the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied. RESET: Reclosing the initiate switch during timing resets the time delay. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, HRPU, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TRDU, TDB Extra Functions Included in Some Delay-on-Break (DOB) Timers: Instantaneous Contacts: Some DOB timers have a set of instantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Instantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. Related Functions: Inverted Delay-on-Break ® Inverted Delay-on-Break: (ProgramaCube Function UB) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon closure of the initiate switch S1, the output (relay or solid state) de-energizes. The time delay begins when S1 is opened. The output remains de-energized during timing. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes. The output remains de-energized if S1 is closed when input voltage is applied RESET: Reclosing S1 during timing resets the time delay. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, HRPU, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TRDU Legend V = Voltage R = Reset T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time S1 =Initiate Switch 158 NO = Normally Open Contact NC = Normally Closed Contact t = Incomplete Time Delay TD, TD1, TD2 = Time Delay = Undefined Time www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix A - Timer Functions ® Single Shot: (ProgramaCube Functions S or SD) (Pulse Former, One Shot Relay, Single Shot Interval, Pulse Shaping) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch, the output (relay or solid state) energizes and the time delay begins. At the end of the delay, the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing the initiate switch during timing has no effect on the time delay. Note (for most single shot timers): If the initiate switch is closed when input voltage is applied, the output energizes and the time delay begins. RESET: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and the initiate switch is opened. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, HRPU, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TDS, TSDS, TRDU Single Shot (Pulse Former) Extra Functions Included in Some Single Shot Timers: Instantaneous Contacts: Some Single Shot timers have a set of instantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Instantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. Related Functions: ® Retriggerable Single Shot (Motion Detector): (ProgramaCube Function PSD) (Motion Detector, Zero Speed Switch, Watchdog Timer, Missing Pulse Timer) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied prior to and during timing. The output (relay or solid state) is de-energized. When the initiate switch S1 closes momentarily or maintained, the output energizes and the time delay begins. Upon completion of the delay, the output de-energizes. RESET: Reclosing S1 resets the time delay and restarts timing. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRD9, HRPS, HRPU, KRD9, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TRDU, TRU ® Retriggerable Single Shot (Motion Detector): (ProgramaCube Function PSE) OPERATION: Similar to retriggerable single shot function PSD above except, when input voltage is applied, the output (relay or solid state) immediately energizes and timing begins. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. The unit will timeout as long as S1 remains open or closed for a full time delay period. RESET: During timing, reclosing S1 resets and restarts the time delay and the output remains energized. After timeout, reclosing S1 starts a new operation. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output. See: KRD9 ® Inverted Single Shot: (ProgramaCube Function US) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. Upon momentary or maintained closure of the initiate switch S1, the output (relay or solid state) de-energizes. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes. Opening or reclosing S1 during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will remain de-energized if S1 is closed when input voltage is applied. RESET: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and S1 is open. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output. See: HRPS, HRPU, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPS, NHPU, TRDU ® Trailing Edge Single Shot (Impulse-OFF): (ProgramaCube Function TS) Motion Detector (PSD) Retriggerable Single Shot Motion Detector (PSE) Retriggerable Single Shot Inverted Single Shot Trailing Edge Single Shot OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. When the initiate switch S1 opens, the output (relay or solid state) energizes. At the end of the time delay, the output de-energizes. Reclosing and opening S1 during timing has no affect on the time delay. The output will not energize if S1 is open when input voltage is applied. RESET: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and S1 is closed. Removing input voltage resets the time delay and output.See: HRPS, KRPS, KSPS, KSPU, NHPU, TRDU www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 159 Appendix A - Timer Functions Timer Functions Two Functions in One Timer ® Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break: (ProgramaCube Function MB) (ON-delay/OFF-delay, Delay on Operate/Delay on Release, Sequencing ON & OFF, Fan Delay, Prepurge & Postpurge) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied at all times. The output (relay or solid state) is deenergized. Upon closure of the S1 initiate switch, the delay-on-make time delay (TD1) begins. At the end of TD1, the output (relay or solid state) energizes. Opening S1 starts the delay-on-break time delay (TD2). At the end of TD2, the output de-energizes. RESET: Removing input voltage resets time delays and the output.If S1 is a) opened during TD1, then TD1 is reset and the output remains de-energized. b) reclosed during TD2, then TD2 is reset and the output remains energized. See: HRPD, KRPD, KSPD, NHPD Delay-on-Make/ Delay-on-Break Extra Functions Included in Some Delay-on-Make/Delay-on-Break Timers: Instantaneous Contacts: Some DOM/DOB timers have a set of instantaneous contacts in addition to the delayed contacts. Instantaneous contacts energize when input voltage is applied and remain until voltage is removed. ® Delay-on-Make/Interval: (ProgramaCube Function MI) (Single Pulse Generator, Delayed Interval, Delay on Operate/Single Pulse on Operate) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, the delay-on-make time delay (TD1) begins, the output remains de-energized. At the end of this delay, the output (relay or solid state) energizes and the interval delay (TD2) begins. At the end of the interval delay (TD2), the output de-energizes. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the output, the time delays and returns the sequence to the first delay. See: ESD5, HRPD, KRPD, KSPD, NHPD, TRDU ® Accumulative Delay-on-Make/Interval: (ProgramaCube Function AMI) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during timing. The output is de-energized before and during the TD1 time delay. Each time S1 closes, the time delay progresses; when it opens, timing stops. When the amount of time S1 is closed equals the full TD1 delay, the output (relay or solid state) energizes for TD2. Upon completion of TD2, the output relay de-energizes. Opening S1 during TD2 has no affect. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delay, output relay, and the sequence to the first delay. See: HRPD, KRPD, KSPD, NHPD Delay-on-Make/ Interval Accumulative Delay-on-Make/ Interval Legend V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch R = Reset TD1, TD2 = Time Delay NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed = Undefined Time 160 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix A - Timer Functions Timer Functions Two Functions in One Timer ® Delay-on-Make/Recycle: (ProgramaCube Function MRE) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, TD1 begins and the output (relay or solid state) remains de-energized. At the end of TD1, the TD2 recycle function begins and the output (relay or solid state) cycles ON and OFF for equal delays. This cycle continues until input voltage is removed. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the output and time delays, and returns the sequence to the first delay. See: KSPD, KRPD, NHPD, HRPD, TRDU ® Delay-on-Make/Single Shot: (ProgramaCube Function MS) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage and the closure of S1, TD1 begins and the output (relay or solid state) remains de-energized. The output (relay or solid state) energizes at the end of TD1, and TD2 begins. At the end of TD2, the output (relay or solid state) de-energizes. Opening or reclosing S1 during timing has no affect on the time delays. RESET: Reset occurs when the time delay is complete and S1 is open. Removing input voltage resets the time delay, output, and the sequence to the first delay. See: KSPD, KRPD, NHPD, HRPD, TRDU Delay-on-Make Recycle Delay-on-Make Single Shot ® Interval/Recycle: (ProgramaCube Function IRE) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage TD1 begins. At the same time, the TD2 ON time begins and the output (relay or solid state) energizes. At the end of the ON time, the TD2 OFF time begins and the output de-energizes. The equal ON time OFF time cycle continues until TD1 is completed at which time the output de-energizes. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delays, output, and the sequence to the Interval function. See: KSPD, KRPD, NHPD, HRPD, TRDU ® Delay-on-Break/Recycle: (ProgramaCube Function BRE) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage and the closure of S1, the TD2 ON time begins and the output (relay or solid state) energizes. Upon completion of the ON time, the output de-energizes for the TD2 OFF time. At the end of the OFF time, the equal ON/OFF cycle repeats. When S1 opens, the TD1 delay begins. TD1 and TD2 run concurrently until the completion of TD1 at which time, the TD2 ON/OFF cycle terminates and the output de-energizes. The output energizes if S1 is closed when input voltage is applied. RESET: Reclosing S1 during timing resets the TD1 time delay. Removing input voltage resets the time delay, output, and the sequence to the Delay-on-Break function. See: KSPD, KRPD, NHPD, HRPD, TRDU ® Single Shot/Recycle: (ProgramaCube Function SRE) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage and the closure of S1, TD1 begins. At the same time, the TD2 ON time begins and the output (relay or solid state) energizes. Upon completion of the ON time, the output de-energizes for the TD2 OFF time. At the end of the OFF time, the equal ON/OFF cycle repeats. TD1 and TD2 run concurrently until the completion of TD1 at which time, the TD2 ON/OFF cycle terminates and the output de-energizes. Opening or reclosing S1 during timing has no affect on the time delays. The output will energize if S1 is closed when input voltage is applied. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delay, output, and the sequence to the first delay. See: HRPD, KRPD, KSPD, NHPD, TRDU ® Single Shot/Lockout: (ProgramaCube Function SL) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage and momentary or maintained closure of S1, the output (relay or solid state) energizes and TD1 single shot time delay begins. The output relay deenergizes at the end of TD1 and the TD2 lockout time delay begins. During TD2 (and TD1) closing switch S1 has no effect on the operation. After TD2 is complete, closing S1 starts another operation. If S1 is closed when input voltage is applied, the output energizes and the TD1 time delay begins. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delays and the output and returns the cycle to the first delay. ® Interval/Delay-on-Make: (ProgramaCube Function IM) OPERATION: Upon application of input voltage, the output (relay or solid state) energizes and TD1 begins. At the end of TD1, the output de-energizes and TD2 begins. At the end of TD2, the output energizes. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delays, output, and the sequence to the first delay. See: HRPD, KRPD, KSPD, NHPD, TRDU www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Interval Recycle Delay-on-Break Recycle Single Shot Recycle Single Shot Lockout Interval Delay-on-Make 161 Appendix A - Timer Functions Timer Functions Counting and Switching Functions ® Leading edge flip-flop: (ProgramaCube Function F) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during operation. The operation begins with the output (relay or solid state) de-energized. Upon momentary or maintained closure (leading edge triggered) of the initiate switch S1, the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized. Opening or re-closing S1 during timing has no affect. After the output transfers, the next closure of S1 starts a new operation. Each time an S1 closure is recognized, the time delay occurs and then the output transfers, ON to OFF, OFF to ON, ON to OFF. The first operation will occur if S1 is closed when input voltage is applied. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the time delay and the output to the de-energized state. Function can be applied to ProgramaCube Series: HRPS, KRPS, KSPS Leading Edge Flip-Flop ® Alternating Relay (Trailing edge flip-flop): (ProgramaCube Function FT) Trailing Edge Flip-Flop (Alternating Relay) OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied at all times for proper operation. The operation begins with the output (relay or solid state) de-energized. Closing S1 enables the next alternating operation. When S1 opens (trailing edge triggered), the time delay begins. At the end of the time delay, the output energizes and remains energized until S1 is (re-closed and) re-opened. Then the output relay de-energizes and remains until S1 opens again. Each time S1 opens the time delay occurs and the output transfers. RESET: Removing input voltage resets the output and the time delay. See: ARP, HRPS, KRPS ® Counter with Pulsed Output: (ProgramaCube Function C) ® Function Limited to Switch Adjustable ProgramaCubes OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during operation. Each time S1 is closed, a count is added. When the total number of S1 closures equals the total count selected on the unit, the output energizes. The output remains energized for the pulse duration specified for the product, and then de-energizes. If S1 is closed while the output is energized, a count is not added. If S1 is closed when input voltage is applied, a count is not added. RESET: The unit automatically resets at the end of each operation. Removing input voltage resets the output, counter, and pulse delay. See: HRPU, KSPU, NHPU ® Counter with Interval Output: (ProgramaCube Function CI) Counter with Pulsed Output Counter with Interval Output ® Function Limited to Switch Adjustable ProgramaCubes OPERATION: Input voltage must be applied before and during operation. Each time S1 is closed, a count is added. When the total number of S1 closures equals the total count selected on the unit, the output energizes and the interval time delay begins. The output de-energizes at the end of the time delay. If S1 is closed during the time delay, a count is not added. If S1 is closed when input voltage is applied, a count is not added. RESET: The counter is reset during the time delay, the unit automatically resets at the end of the interval time delay. Removing input voltage resets the output, counter, and time delay. See: HRPU, HRV, HSPZ, KSPU, NHPU Legend V = Voltage R = Reset S1 = Initiate Switch Td, TD1, TD2 = Time Delay NO = Normally Open Contact NC = Normally Closed Contact C = Count P = Pulse Duration = Undefined Time 162 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix A - Timer Functions TRDU Function Diagrams Single Functions Dual Functions * Delay-on-Make Delay-on-Make Delay-on-Break Delay-on-Break * Delay-on-Make Recycle (ON Time First) * Recycle * Delay-on-Make Interval Single Shot Delay-on-Make Single Shot * Interval * Interval Recycle (ON Time First) Trailing Edge Single Shot Delay-on-Break Recycle (ON Time First) Inverted Single Shot Single Shot Recycle (ON Time First) (ON Time First, Equal Delays) US Inverted Delay-on-Break * Recycle (ON Time First) Both Times Adjustable * 9 Functions included in the 8 pin DPDT models Continued on next page... www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 163 Appendix A - Timer/Flasher Functions Single Functions Dual Functions Retriggerable Single Shot * Recycle (OFF Time First) Accumulative Delay-on-Make * Interval Delay-on-Make KEY Both Times Adjustable V=Voltage, R=Reset, S1=Initiate Switch, NO=Normally Open Contact, NC=Normally Closed Contact, TD,TD1,TD2=Complete Time Delay, t=Partial Time Delay, DOM=Delay-on-Make, DOB=Delay-on-Break, REC=Recycle, SS=Single Shot, INT=Interval, M=Minutes, S=Seconds, = Undefined time 5 Switches for Function Selection 3 Switches for Time Delay Range NOTE: The time delay range is the same for both functions when dual functions are selected. Accumulative Delay-on-Make Interval * 9 Functions included in the 8 pin DPDT models Flasher Function Diagrams Flasher (NC) V = Voltage S1 = Initiate Switch L = Load R = Reset T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time T1 ≅ T2 Flasher (Alternating) V = Voltage L1 = Load 1 L2 = Load 2 R = Reset T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time T1 ≅ T2 Flashers & Aux. Modules Flasher (OFF First) V = Voltage R = Reset L = Load T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time T1 ≅ T2 Flasher (ON First-DPDT) V = Voltage R = Reset T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed Flasher (ON First) V = Voltage R = Reset L = Load T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time T1 ≅ T2 ON time plus OFF time equals one complete flash. Flasher (Chasing) SC4 shown; SC3, L4 is eliminated and L1 TD begins as soon as L3 TD is completed. V = Voltage R = Reset L (1...4) = Lamps TD = Time Delay (all are equal) V = Voltage L = Load T1 = ON Time T2 = OFF Time R = Reset T1 ≅ T2 164 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix B - Dimensional Drawings FIGURE 1 CT; ESD5; ESDR; FS100; FS200; FS300; KRD3; KRD9; KRDB; KRDI; KRDM; KRDR; KRDS; KRPD; KRPS; KSD1; KSD2; KSD3; KSD4; KSDB; KSDR; KSDS; KSDU; KSPD; KSPS; KSPU; KVM; T2D; TA; TAC1; TAC4; TDU; TDUB; TDUI; TDUS; TL; TMV8000; TS1; TS2; TS4; TS6; TSB; TSD1; TSD2; TSD3; TSD4; TSD6; TSD7; TSDB; TSDR; TSDS; TSS; TSU2000 FIGURE 4 FIGURE 2 FIGURE 3 HLV; HRD3; HRD9; HRDB; HRDI; HRDM; HRDR; HRDS; HRID; HRIS; HRIU; HRPD; HRPS; HRPU; HRV; RS HSPZ FIGURE 5 FIGURE 6 TRDU TRU FA; FS; FSU1000*; NHPD; NHPS; NHPU; NLF1*; NLF2*; PHS*; PTHF*; SIR1; SIR2; SLR1*; SLR2*; TH1; TH2; THC; THD1; THD2; THD3; THD4; THD7; THDB; THDM; THDS; THS *If unit is rated @ 1A, see Figure 1 FIGURE 7 FIGURE 8 FIGURE 9 PLM; PLR; TDB; TDBH; TDBL; TDI; TDIH; TDIL; TDM; TDMB; TDMH; TDML; TDR; TDS; TDSH; TDSL FS500; PRLB; PRLM; PRLS; TRB; TRM; TRS (snap for mounting bases) FIGURE 11 ASQU; ASTU; DSQU; DSTU FIGURE 12 3.69 (93.7) 2.94 (74.7) 0.8 (20.3) 1.70 (43.2) 0.94 (23.88) 1.50 (38.1) 3.5 (88.9) 2.12 (53.8) 0.25 (6.35) 0.187 (4.75) 1.94 (49.3) 2.50 (63.5) ERD3; ERDI; ERDM www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 0.163 (4.14) 0.25 (6.35) 1.50 (38.1) 1.88 (47.8) 0.38 “P” clamp (P1023-2) 1.5 (38.1) 3.00 (76.2) FIGURE 10 0.5 (12.7) 1.0 (25.4) 0.19 (4.83) FS100; FS400 (9.7) ORB; ORM; ORS 0.50 (12.7) inches (millimeters) 165 Appendix B - Dimensional Drawings FIGURE 13 FIGURE 15 FIGURE 14 3.5 (88.9) 2.94 (74.7) 1.22 (31) 0.25 (6.35) 1.94 (49.3) 5.9 (149.9) 2.5 (63.5) 0.187 (4.75) DIA. SC3; SC4; SQ AF 0.25 (6.35) 6.9 (175.3) 0.80 (20.32) 0.50 (12.7) FIGURE 16 3.3 (83.8) FIGURE 17 0.55 (13.97) 4.4 (111.8) 2.2 (55.9) 2.4 (61.0) WVM 0.68 (17.27) FB9L; HLMU; SCR9L DLMU FIGURE 20 FIGURE 18 0.36 (9.14) FIGURE 19 3.5 (88.9) 2.94 (74.7) PLMU 0.80 (20.3) LLC4; LLC6; PLS FIGURE 21 0.25 (6.35) DIA. FIGURE 22 0.25 (6.35) 1.94 (49.3) 2.5 (63.5) 1.75 (44.5) ECS; ECSW 0.187 (4.75) (ECS has spade connectors and ECSW has terminal board) FIGURE 23 0.36 (9.14) DIA. 2.0 (50.8) 2.0 (50.8) TCS; TCSA 0.75 (19.05) 1.75 (44.5) LCS DCSA inches (millimeters) 166 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix B - Dimensional Drawings FIGURE 25 FIGURE 24 CURRENT LIMITING RESISTOR 0.94 (23.88) 0.28 (7.11) 24 AWG (0.25 mm2 ) UL1007 STRIPPED 0.25 (6.35) 12 ± 1 (304.8 ± 25.4) FIGURE 26 “P” clamp (P1023-2) 1.0 (25.4) 1.5 (38.1) 3.5 (88.9) 0.19 (4.83) <_ 0.22 2.08 (52.8) 0.5 (12.7) (5.59) 0.53 (13.46) 0.22 (5.59) LPM 2.10 (53.3) FIGURE 27 0.163 (4.14) 14AWG 0.065 (1.65) MSM 4.0 (101.6) 2.07 (52.6) 0.234 (5.94) 0.94 (23.9) 0.285 (7.24) 2.75 (69.9) 0.25 (6.35) 0.50 (12.7) 2.0 (50.8) 0.5 (12.7) 0.94 (23.88) 0.163 (4.14) = Nylon Standoffs LLC1 FIGURE 28 3.0 (76.2) 0.5 (12.7) 2.0 (50.8) 0.44 (11.35) 0.25 (6.35) 3.62 (91.9) 3.5 (88.9) 2.12 (53.8) 2.5 (63.5) 0.19 (4.83) 0.25 (6.35) FIGURE 29 [ ] [ ] [ [ ] ] LLC5 LLC2 LLC8 FIGURE 30 FIGURE 33 FIGURE 32 0.187 (4.75) 2.94 (74.7) TVM; TVW 0.80 (20.3) 0.28 (7.1) 0.36 (9.1) 3.5 (88.9) FIGURE 31 1.94 (49.3) 2.5 (63.5) 0.28 (7.1) 1.75 (44.5) FB; SCR ARP PCR inches (millimeters) www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 167 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams FIGURE 1 - FSU1000 Series L1 FIGURE 2 - FS100 Series L1 N/L2 S1 = Optional low current switch V = Voltage L = Load FIGURE 3 - FS100 Series L1 N V = Voltage L = Load R = Red Wire B = Black Wire FIGURE 5 - FS300 Series FIGURE 4 - FS200 Series N/L2 V = Voltage L = Load V = Voltage L = Load FIGURE 6 - FS400 Series L1 FIGURE 7 - AF Series L1 N/L2 FIGURE 8 - FS500 Series N/L2 L1 V = Voltage L = Load Note: Load may be in positive side. FIGURE 9 - SC3/SC4 Series L1 V = Voltage L = Load R = Red Wire B = Black Wire W= White Wire V = Voltage N/L2 V = Voltage L = Load FIGURE 11 - DLMU Series FIGURE 10 - WVM Series N/L2 ! SC4 shown; for SC3, terminal 6 & load L4 are eliminated. FIGURE 12 - HLMU Series L1, L2, L3 = Line Voltage Input NO = Normally Open Contact NC = Normally Closed Contact C = Common, Transfer Contact CAUTION: 2 amp max. fast acting fuses are recommended to protect the equipment‘s wiring. They are not required to protect the DLMU. ! = Select alarm contact connection as N.O. or N.C. when ordering; N.O. Shown. F = Fuses NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed RS = Optional Remote Reset Switch Relay contacts are isolated. CAUTION: 2 amp max fast acting fuses must be installed externally in series with each input. (3) FIGURE 14 TVM/TVW Series FIGURE 13 PLMU/PLM/PLR/PLS Series Note: Relay contacts are isolated, 277VAC max. L1, L2, L3 = Line Voltage Input NO = Normally Open Contact NC = Normally Closed Contact C = Common, Transfer Contact CAUTION: 2 amp max. fast acting fuses are recommended to protect the equipment‘s wiring. They are not required to protect the HLMU. 168 F = Fuses ØA = Phase A = L1 ØB = Phase B = L2 ØC = Phase C = L3 NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed 2A fast acting fuses recommended for safety (not required) Relay contacts are isolated. L1 = Phase A L2 = Phase B L3 = Phase C NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common, Transfer Contact Relay contacts are isolated. F = 2A Fast acting fuses are recommended, but not required www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams FIGURE 16 - KVM Series FIGURE 15 - HLV Series L1 L1 N/L2 N/L2 L1 N/L2 I = Relay contacts are isolated. V = Voltage L = LED S = Undervoltage Setpoint NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common, Transfer Contact N = Relay contacts are non-isolated. NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common T1 = Undervoltage Trip Point T2 = Restart Delay FIGURE 18 - ECSW Series FIGURE 17 - ECS Series L1 N/L2 L1 N/L2 V = Voltage I> = Overcurrent I< = Undercurrent W = Insulated Wire Carrying Monitored Current Relay contacts are isolated. MC = Motor Contactor M = Motor F = Fuses OL = Overload RSW = Reset Switch V = Voltage I> = Adjustable Overcurrent I< = Adjustable Undercurrent W = Monitored Wire ∆T - Adjustable Trip Delay FSW = Fan or Float Contacts CR = Control Relay CS = Current Sensor MCC = Motor Contactor Coil FIGURE 19 - TCS Series FIGURE 21 - DCSA Series Positive Switching Connection Connection forfor 4 - 20 mA Loop 4-20mA Loop FIGURE 20 - TCSA Series PS LCSC10T12 LCSC10T12 Current CurrentSensor Sensor Connect One: A = 1 to 5VDC Current measuring B = 2 to 10VDC device Negative Switching L1 N/L2 PS = Power Supply Z = Zero Adjust S = Span Adjust W = Insulated Wire Carrying Monitored Current PLC = PLC Analog Input or Meter Input Sinking To LCSC10T12 LCSC10T12 To Current Sensor Current Jumper used when current is not Jumper source used when LCSC10T12 current source is not LCSC10T12 C D Connection for L = Load V = Voltage PS = Power Supply PLC = PLC Digital Input Module Sourcing Analog Voltage Connection for Output Analog Voltage Output Connect One: A = 1 to 5VDC Voltage B = 2 tomeasuring 10VDC D A device B Monitored AC conductor must be insulated. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 AD = Instrument, Meter, or PLC Input Connect One: PS==1Power Supply to 5VDC VDA VDB = 2 to 10VDC AD = Instrument, meter or PLC input PS = Power Supply 169 249 249 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams FIGURE 23 - LLC1 Series FIGURE 22 - LCS10T12 FIGURE 24 - LLC4 Series C Metal Tank or use additional Probe Wire Length: 500 ft. (152.4m) max. (Customer Supplied) CAUTION: The LCS10T12 must be connected to the LPM12 or LPMG12 before current flows to prevent damage or shock hazard. Monitored wires must be properly insulated. FIGURE 25 - LLC8 Series L1 N/L2 Metal Tank or use additional Probe P = Probe L = Load V = Voltage ∆S = Sensitivity Adjustment Connect common to conductive tank or an additional probe as required. Contacts A, B & C are isolated. FIGURE 26 - LLC6 Series L1 N/L2 P = Probe C = Probe Common V = Voltage Relay contacts are isolated. Connect common to conductive tank. Additional probe is necessary for non-conductive or insulated tanks. FIGURE 27 - LLC2 Series N/L2 L1 Metal Tank or use additional Probe Metal Tank or use additional Probe V = Voltage LLCO = Low Level Probe G or CP = Ground or Common (Reference) Probe R = Optional NC Reset Switch (not included) NO = Normally Open NC = Normally Closed C = Common or Transfer Contact Relay contacts are isolated. Connect common to conductive tank. Additional probe is necessary for non-conductive or insulated tanks. PC = Probe Common P = Probe V = Voltage R = Optional NC Reset Switch Connect common to conductive tank. Additional probe is necessary for non-conductive or insulated tanks. FIGURE 29 - ARP Series L1 Metal Tank or use additional Probe V = Voltage L1 N/L2 L = Low Probe H = High Probe C = Probe Common ∆S = Sensitivity Adjustment NC = Normally Closed NO = Normally Open Connect common to conductive tank. Additional probe is necessary for nonconductive or insulated tanks. N/L2 SPDT 8-pin FIGURE 28 - LLC5 Series L1 N/L2 DPDT 11-pin Metal Tank or use additional Probe L1 N/L2 HP = High Level Probe LP = Low Level Probe C = Probe Common V = Voltage Relay contacts are isolated. Connect common to conductive tank. Additional probe is necessary for non-conductive or insulated tanks. Relay contacts in above are isolated. L1 N/L2 DPDT 8-pin cross wired Duplexing (Cross Wired): Duplexing models operate the same as alternating relays and when both the Control (S1) and Lag Load (S2) Switches are closed, Load A and Load B energize simultaneously. V = Voltage LA = Load A LB = Load B S1 = Primary Control Switch S2 = Lag Load Switch 170 The DPDT 8-pin, cross wired option, allows extra system load capacity through simultaneous operation of both motors when needed. Relay contacts are not isolated. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams FIGURE 30 - FS155 & FS165 & FA Series N/L2 N/L2 L1 L1 (H) FIGURE 31 - FB Series L1 L2 (H) L1 L1 N/L2 N/L2 V = Voltage B = Beacon F = Flasher BRC = Flasher Bypass Relay Contacts T = Toroid AR = FB Alarm Relay BR = Bypass Relay Coil FL = Flasher Failure LED LL = Lamp Failure LED AXL = Lamp Alarm Relay Coil NOTE: Flasher module may be located on either the line or load side of the toroidal sensor. F = Flasher (FS155-30T, FS155-30RF, FS165-30T, FS165-30RF) AX = Auxiliary Unit B = Beacon DL = Dummy Load for Constant Line Loading Rd = 3.3 KΩ @ 5W for 120VAC 8.5 KΩ @ 5W for 230VAC FIGURE 33 - SCR Series Beacon Connection Diagram L1 N/L2 FIGURE 32 - SCR490D L1 N/L2 Obstruction Lamp Connection Diagram L1 N/L2 V = Voltage OL = Obstruction Lamps T = Toroid SS = Selector Switch AXL = Auxiliary Load/Alarm Relay contacts are isolated. V = Voltage B = Beacon Lamps SS = Selector Switch T = Toroid F = Flasher AXL = Auxiliary Load/Alarm OL = Obstruction Lamps Relay contacts are isolated. www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 171 Appendix C - Connection Diagrams FIGURE 34 - FB9L FIGURE 35 - SCR9L L1 N/L2 Beacon Connection Diagram L1 V = Voltage B = LED Beacon SS = Selector Switch SI = Sensor Input L = Indicator F = Flasher Failure LED AXL = Auxiliary Load/Alarm FF = Flasher Failure/Bypass Relay BRC = Bypass Relay Contacts Obstruction Lamp Connection Diagram N/L2 L1 N/L2 V = Voltage B = Beacon Lamps SS = Selector Switch L = LED Indicator F = Flasher AXL = Auxiliary Load/Alarm OL = Obstruction Lamps SI = Sensor Input H = “3“ Spare AC Hot Connection (2A max.) FIGURE 36 - PCR Series FIGURE 37 - SIR1/SIR2 Series L1 N/L2 V = Voltage CV = Control Voltage R = Reset NC = Normally Closed Output NO = Normally Open Output = Undefined time Load may be connected to terminal 3 or 1. Note: Normally open output is shown. Normally closed output is also available. Dashed lines are internal connections. FIGURE 38- SLR Series L1 N/L2 L = Load S1 = Initiate Switch Note: Normally open output is shown. Normally closed output is also available. 172 FIGURE 39 - NLF1/NLF2 Series L1 N/L2 L = Load S1 = Control Switch Internal connections between terminals 2 & 4. FIGURE 40 - PHS Series L1 N/L2 Triac Output Device V = Voltage L = Load RT = External Adjustment www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 NOTES www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 173 NOTES 174 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 NOTES www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 175 NOTES 176 www.ssac.com • 800-843-8848 • fax: 605-348-5685 For over 85 years, Littelfuse products have helped protect electrical equipment used in mining, petrochem, marine, alternative energy, HVAC and other industrial applications. We offer Littelfuse Startco protection relays and custom power centers as well as Littelfuse Selco generator protection, controls and alarm panels. Now a part of Littelfuse, SymCom and SSAC manufacture electronic products for monitoring, protecting and controlling motors, pumps, timing controls, and custom designs. Littelfuse electrical product portfolio includes: Littelfuse products are certified to many standards around the world. To check certifications on a specific product please refer to the product datasheet on Littelfuse.com. Littelfuse World Headquarters 8755 West Higgins Road, Suite 500 Chicago, IL 60631 USA Tel: +1-800-832-3873 Fax: +1-847-787-5190 E-mail: [email protected] Littelfuse Startco 3714 Kinnear Place Saskatoon, SK S7P 0A6 Canada Tel: +1-306-373-5505 Fax: +1-306-374-2245 E-mail: [email protected] Littelfuse Selco Betonvej 10 DK- 4000 Roskilde Denmark Tel: + 45-70 26 11 22 Fax: + 45-70 26 25 22 E-mail: [email protected] Littelfuse Selco ME L.L.C P.O. Box 52898 Dubai United Arab Emirates Tel: + 971-4 3413660 Fax: + 971-2 3413770 E-mail: [email protected] SymCom 222 Disk Drive Rapid City, SD 57701 USA Tel: + 1-800-843-8848 Fax: + 1-605-348-5685 E-mail: [email protected] WWW.SSAC.COM F or 85 years, Littelfuse electrical safety products have helped OEM engineers, consulting engineers and end-users select the right products to protect critical electrical equipment—all supported by our full line of product catalogs and reference materials. Arc-Flash Relay Brochure Littelfuse offers one of the fastest Arc-Flash Protection relays on the Motor Protection Relay Brochure Littelfuse provides a range of multi-function motor protection market. The PGR-8800 can detect a developing arc flash extremely fast and send a trip signal before any significant damage occurs. products that reliably protect small, medium and large motors. Generator Controls and Alarm Panels Littelfuse Selco provides generator control, diagnostics and protection products as well as alarm annunciation and indication panels. Fuses and Fuse Holders Catalog L ittelfuse POWR-GARD® offers a complete circuit-protection portfolio, including time saving indication products for an instant visual blown fuse identification, even on de-energized systems. To request catalogues for the entire Littelfuse portfolio of products, please contact your authorized Littelfuse sales representative or visit our website at Littelfuse.com/catalogs Scan with your mobile device to download this catalog. © 2015 Littelfuse, Inc. Printed in USA. Specifications, descriptions and illustrative material in this literature are as accurate as known at the time of publication, but are subject to changes without notice. Visit SymCom.com for the most up-to-date technical information. FORM NO: RC206 Rev: 1-A-032715